blob: 68bb2b072339ddd094f924fd1442d23c8e066451 [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner5b12ab82007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall83024632010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregorc3a6ade2010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Chris Lattnercb6a3822006-11-10 06:20:45 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbar6e8aa532008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Naroff021ca182008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall8b0666c2010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCallde6836a2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +000041
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
53/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattnerb7df3c62009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
John McCall28a6aea2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000059 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Benjamin Kramerbfac7dc2010-10-09 15:49:00 +000060 if (const DeprecatedAttr *DA = D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
61 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, DA->getMessage(), Loc);
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000062
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000063 // See if the decl is unavailable
Fariborz Jahanianc74073c2010-10-06 23:12:32 +000064 if (const UnavailableAttr *UA = D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
65 if (UA->getMessage().empty())
66 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
67 else
68 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable_message)
Benjamin Kramerbfac7dc2010-10-09 15:49:00 +000069 << D->getDeclName() << UA->getMessage();
Chris Lattnera27dd592009-10-25 17:21:40 +000070 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
71 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +000072
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000073 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000074 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000075 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
76 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
77 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
78 return true;
79 }
Douglas Gregorde681d42009-02-24 04:26:15 +000080 }
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000081
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +000082 return false;
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000083}
84
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000085/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000086/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +000087/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
88///
89void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000090 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +000091 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000092 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000093 return;
Douglas Gregorc298ffc2010-04-22 16:44:27 +000094
95 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
96 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +000097 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
98 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +000099
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000100 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
101 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000102 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000103 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
104 int isMethod = 0;
105 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
106 // skip over named parameters.
107 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
108 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
109 if (nullPos)
110 --nullPos;
111 else
112 ++i;
113 }
114 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
115 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000116 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000117 // skip over named parameters.
118 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
119 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
120 if (nullPos)
121 --nullPos;
122 else
123 ++i;
124 }
125 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000126 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000127 // block or function pointer call.
128 QualType Ty = V->getType();
129 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000130 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000131 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
132 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000133 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
134 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
135 unsigned k;
136 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
137 if (nullPos)
138 --nullPos;
139 else
140 ++i;
141 }
142 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
143 }
144 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
145 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000146 } else
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000147 return;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000148 } else
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000149 return;
150
151 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000152 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000153 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000154 return;
155 }
156 int sentinel = i;
157 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
158 --sentinelPos;
159 ++i;
160 }
161 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
162 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian4a528032009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000163 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian9e877212009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000164 return;
165 }
166 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
167 ++i;
168 ++sentinel;
169 }
170 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000171 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
172 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
173 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Fariborz Jahanianc0b0ced2010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000174 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall7ddbcf42010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000175 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
176 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
177 return;
178
179 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
180 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
181
182 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
183 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian027b8862009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000184}
185
Douglas Gregor87f95b02009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000186SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
187 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
188 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
189}
190
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000191//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
192// Standard Promotions and Conversions
193//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
194
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000195/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
196void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
197 QualType Ty = E->getType();
198 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
199
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000200 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000201 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000202 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000203 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
204 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
205 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
206 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
207 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
208 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
209 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9321c742008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000210 //
211 // C++ 4.2p1:
212 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
213 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
214 //
215 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
216 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson8fc489d2009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000217 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000218 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner61f60a02008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000219 }
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000220}
221
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000222void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
223 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000224
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000225 QualType Ty = E->getType();
226 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
227 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
228 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
229 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
230 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
231 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
232 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
233 // rvalue is T
234 //
235 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000236 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
237 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000238 // type of the lvalue.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000239 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000240 }
241}
242
243
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000244/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000245/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000246/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
247/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
248/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
249Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
250 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
251 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000252
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000253 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
254 //
255 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
256 // unsigned int may be used:
257 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
258 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
259 // and unsigned int.
260 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
261 //
262 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
263 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
264 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
265 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000266 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
267 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000268 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000269 return Expr;
270 }
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000271 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000272 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000273 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor8d9c5092009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000274 return Expr;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000275 }
276
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000277 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000278 return Expr;
279}
280
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000281/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000282/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000283/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
284void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
285 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
286 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000287
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000288 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000289 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
290 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000291 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000292
Chris Lattner2ce500f2008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000293 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
294}
295
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000296/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
297/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
298/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
299/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000300bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
301 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000302 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000303
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000304 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
305 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
306 // etc.
307 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
308 return false;
309
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000310 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000311 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
312 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
313 << Expr->getType() << CT))
314 return true;
Douglas Gregor7ca84af2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000315
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000316 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000317 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000318 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
319 << Expr->getType() << CT))
320 return true;
Chris Lattnera8a7d0f2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000321
322 return false;
Anders Carlssona7d069d2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000323}
324
325
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000326/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
327/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000328/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000329/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
330/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
331/// GCC.
332QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
333 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000334 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000335 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000336
337 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000338
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000339 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000340 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000341 QualType lhs =
342 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000343 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000344 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000345
346 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
347 if (lhs == rhs)
348 return lhs;
349
350 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
351 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
352 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
353 return lhs;
354
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000355 // Perform bitfield promotions.
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000356 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000357 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
358 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000359 QualType RHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000360 if (!RHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
361 rhs = RHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
362
Eli Friedman5ae98ee2009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000363 QualType destType = Context.UsualArithmeticConversionsType(lhs, rhs);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000364 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000365 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
366 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, destType, CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregora11693b2008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000367 return destType;
368}
369
Chris Lattner513165e2008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000370//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
371// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
372//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
373
374
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000375/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000376/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
377/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
378/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
379/// string.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000380///
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000381ExprResult
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000382Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000383 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
384
Chris Lattner8a24e582009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000385 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Steve Naroff4f88b312007-03-13 22:37:02 +0000386 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000387 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000388
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +0000389 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000390 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
391 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000392
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000393 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscbad7252008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000394 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000395 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000396
397 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattnera8687ae2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000398 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000399 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000400
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000401 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
402 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
403 // strings.
404 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerd42c29f2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000405 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattner36fc8792008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000406 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000407
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000408 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Alexis Hunt3b791862010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000409 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
410 Literal.GetStringLength(),
411 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
412 &StringTokLocs[0],
413 StringTokLocs.size()));
Chris Lattner5b183d82006-11-10 05:03:26 +0000414}
415
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000416/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
417/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
418/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
419/// for values inside the block or for globals).
420///
Douglas Gregor4f13beb2010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000421/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000422/// up-to-date.
423///
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000424static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000425 ValueDecl *VD) {
426 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
427 // we wanted to.
428 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
429 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000430
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000431 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
432 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
433 return false;
434
435 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
436 // snapshot it.
437 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
438 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000439 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
440 return false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000441
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000442 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
443 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
444
445 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
446 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
447 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
448 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000449 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
450 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000451
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000452 if (!NextBlock)
453 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000454
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000455 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
456 // having a reference outside it.
457 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
458 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000459
Chris Lattner497d7b02009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000460 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
461 // a snapshot as well.
462 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
463 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000464
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000465 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000466}
467
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000468
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000469ExprResult
John McCallce546572009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000470Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000471 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000472 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
473 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
474}
475
476/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000477ExprResult
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000478Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
479 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
480 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000481 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000482 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000483 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlsson364035d12009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000484 << D->getDeclName();
485 return ExprError();
486 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000487
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000488 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000489 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
490 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
491 // visible.
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000492 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15243332010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000493 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000494 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
495 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000496 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
497 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000498 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000499 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlsson946b86d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000500 << D->getIdentifier();
501 return ExprError();
502 }
503 }
504 }
505 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000506
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000507 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000508
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000509 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
510 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
511 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000512 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregorc7acfdf2009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000513}
514
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000515/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
516/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
517/// actual member.
518///
519/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
520/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
521/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
522/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
523/// we found.
524///
525/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
526/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
527/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
528VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
529 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000530 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
531 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
532 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
533
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000534 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000535 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
536 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
537 do {
538 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCall61925b02010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000539 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000540 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000541 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000542 else {
543 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
544 break;
545 }
546 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000547 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000548 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000549
550 return BaseObject;
551}
552
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000553ExprResult
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000554Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
555 FieldDecl *Field,
556 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
557 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
558 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000559 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregord5846a12009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000560 AnonFields);
561
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000562 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
563 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
564 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
565 // found via name lookup.
566 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000567 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000568 if (BaseObject) {
569 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
570 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000571 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000572 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Devang Patele25b5f82010-10-12 23:23:25 +0000573 Loc);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000574 BaseQuals
575 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000576 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
577 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
578 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
579 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
580 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000581 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000582 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
583 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
584 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000585 BaseQuals
586 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000587 } else {
588 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
589 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
590 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000591 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
592 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000593 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000594 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000595 = Context.getTagDeclType(
596 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
597 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000598 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000599 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
600 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
601 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor4b654412009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000602 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000603 MD->getThisType(Context),
604 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000605 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
606 }
607 } else {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000608 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
609 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000610 }
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000611 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000612 }
613
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000614 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000615 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
616 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000617 }
618
619 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
620 // anonymous struct/union.
621 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000622 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000623 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
624 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
625 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
626 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000627 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
628 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
629
630 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
631 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
632 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
633 ResultQuals.removeConst();
634
635 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
636 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
637
638 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
639 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
640
641 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
642 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
643 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
644
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000645 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000646 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000647 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000648 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
649 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000650 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000651 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000652 }
653
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000654 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000655}
656
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000657/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000658/// possibly a list of template arguments.
659///
660/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
661/// DecomposeTemplateName.
662///
663/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
664/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
665/// some way.
666static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
667 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
668 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000669 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000670 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
671 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
672 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
673 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
674
675 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
676 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
677 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
678 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
679 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
680
John McCall3e56fd42010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000681 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000682 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
683 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000684 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
685 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000686 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000687 TemplateArgs = 0;
688 }
689}
690
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000691/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
692/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
693/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000694static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000695 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
696 return false;
697
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000698 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
699 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
700 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
701 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
702 if (!BaseRT) return false;
703
704 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall69f9dbc2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000705 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000706 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
707 return false;
708 }
709
710 return true;
711}
712
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000713/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
714/// the prospective base classes.
715static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
716 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
717 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000718 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000719 return false;
720
Douglas Gregor0a5a2212010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000721 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCalla6d407c2009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000722 if (!RD) return false;
723 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
724
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000725 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
726 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
727 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
728 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
729 if (!BaseRT) return false;
730
731 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000732 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
733 return false;
734 }
735
736 return true;
737}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000738
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000739enum IMAKind {
740 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
741 IMA_Static,
742
743 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
744 IMA_Mixed,
745
746 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
747 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
748 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
749
750 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
751 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
752 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
753
754 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
755 IMA_Instance,
756
757 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
758 IMA_Unresolved,
759
760 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
761 /// context is not an instance method.
762 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
763
764 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
765 /// non-class context.
766 IMA_AnonymousMember,
767
768 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
769 /// context is not an instance method.
770 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
771
772 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
773 /// class.
774 IMA_Error_Unrelated
775};
776
777/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
778/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
779/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
780/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
781/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
782/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
783static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
784 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +0000785 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000786
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000787 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000788 bool isStaticContext =
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000789 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
790 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000791
792 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
793 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
794
795 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
796 bool hasNonInstance = false;
797 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
798 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +0000799 NamedDecl *D = *I;
800 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000801 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
802
803 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
804 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
805 // that's a special case.
806 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
807 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
808 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
809 }
810 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
811 }
812 else
813 hasNonInstance = true;
814 }
815
816 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
817 // member reference.
818 if (Classes.empty())
819 return IMA_Static;
820
821 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
822 // an implicit member reference.
823 if (isStaticContext)
824 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
825
826 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
827 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
828 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
829 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000830 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000831 Classes))
832 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
833
834 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
835}
836
837/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
838static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
839 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
840 const LookupResult &R) {
841 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
842 SourceRange Range(Loc);
843 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
844
845 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
846 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
847 if (MD->isStatic()) {
848 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
849 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
850 << Range << R.getLookupName();
851 return;
852 }
853 }
854
855 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
856 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
857 return;
858 }
859
860 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000861}
862
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000863/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
864///
865/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000866bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
867 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000868 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
869
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000870 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000871 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000872 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
873 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000874 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000875 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000876 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
877 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000878
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000879 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
880 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
881 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
882 // dependent name.
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000883 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000884 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000885 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
886 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
887
888 if (!R.empty()) {
889 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
890 R.suppressDiagnostics();
891
892 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
893 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
894 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
895 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
896
897 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
898 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
899 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000900 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000901 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
902 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000903 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000904 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000905 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000906 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
907 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
908 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
909 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
910 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
911 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
912 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
913 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
914 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
915 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
916 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
917 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
918 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
919 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000920 } else {
Nick Lewyckyfe712382010-08-20 20:54:15 +0000921 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
922 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
923 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedman04831922010-08-22 01:00:03 +0000924 }
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000925 } else {
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000926 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewyckyc96c37f2010-07-06 19:51:49 +0000927 }
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000928
929 // Do we really want to note all of these?
930 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
931 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
932
933 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
934 return false;
935 }
Douglas Gregor86b8d9f2010-08-09 22:38:14 +0000936
937 R.clear();
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +0000938 }
939 }
940
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000941 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000942 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbarf7ced252010-06-02 15:46:52 +0000943 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000944 if (!R.empty()) {
945 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
946 if (SS.isEmpty())
947 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
948 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
949 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
950 else
951 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
952 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
953 << SS.getRange()
954 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
955 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
956 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
957 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
958 << ND->getDeclName();
959
960 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
961 return false;
962 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000963
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000964 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
965 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
966 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
967 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
968 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
969 // to recover well anyway.
970 if (SS.isEmpty())
971 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
972 else
973 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
974 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
975 << SS.getRange();
976
977 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
978 return true;
979 }
980 } else {
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +0000981 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000982 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000983 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000984 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000985 else
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000986 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +0000987 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
988 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000989 return true;
990 }
Douglas Gregor25363982010-01-01 00:15:04 +0000991 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor598b08f2009-12-31 05:20:13 +0000992 }
993
994 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
995 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
996 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
997 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
998 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
999 << SS.getRange();
1000 return true;
1001 }
1002
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001003 // Give up, we can't recover.
1004 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1005 return true;
1006}
1007
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001008static ObjCPropertyDecl *OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001009 IdentifierInfo *II,
1010 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001011 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
1012 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1013 if (!IDecl)
1014 return 0;
1015 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1016 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1017 return 0;
1018 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1019 if (!property)
1020 return 0;
1021 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1022 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic)
1023 return 0;
1024 return property;
1025}
1026
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001027static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001028 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001029 IdentifierInfo *II,
1030 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1031 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001032 bool LookForIvars;
1033 if (Lookup.empty())
1034 LookForIvars = true;
1035 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1036 LookForIvars = false;
1037 else
1038 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1039 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1040 if (!LookForIvars)
1041 return 0;
1042
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001043 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1044 if (!IDecl)
1045 return 0;
1046 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001047 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1048 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001049 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1050 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1051 if (!property)
1052 return 0;
1053 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
1054 DynamicImplSeen =
1055 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
1056 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian2a360892010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001057 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1058 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001059 NameLoc,
1060 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1061 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1062 (Expr *)0, true);
1063 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1064 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1065 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1066 return Ivar;
1067 }
1068 return 0;
1069}
1070
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001071ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001072 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1073 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1074 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1075 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001076 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1077 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1078
1079 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregored8f2882009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001080 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001081
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001082 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001083
1084 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001085 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001086 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001087 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor90a1a652009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001088
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001089 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor4ea80432008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001090 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001091 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001092
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001093 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1094 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregorea0a0a92010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001095 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1096 // (note: handled after lookup)
1097 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1098 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1099 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001100 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1101 // names a dependent type.
1102 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1103 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman964dbda2010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001104 bool DependentID = false;
1105 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1106 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1107 DependentID = true;
1108 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1109 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1110 if (DC) {
1111 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1112 return ExprError();
1113 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1114 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1115 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1116 } else {
1117 DependentID = true;
1118 }
1119 }
1120
1121 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001122 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001123 TemplateArgs);
1124 }
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001125 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001126 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001127 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001128 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregor3e51e172010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001129 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1130 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1131 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1132 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1133 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor786123d2010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001134 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1135 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1136 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001137 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001138 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001139 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001140
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001141 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1142 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001143 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001144 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001145 if (E.isInvalid())
1146 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001147
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001148 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1149 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001150 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1151 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian7b70eb42010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001152 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanian18722982010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001153 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1154 isAddressOfOperand);
1155 }
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001156 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1157 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffebf4cb42008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001158 }
Chris Lattner59a25942008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001159 }
Douglas Gregorf15f5d32009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001160
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001161 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1162 return ExprError();
1163
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001164 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1165 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001166 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001167
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001168 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Bill Wendling4073ed52007-02-13 01:51:42 +00001169 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001170 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1171 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1172 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1173 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1174 }
1175
1176 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1177 // call, diagnose the problem.
1178 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor5fd04d42010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001179 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCalld681c392009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001180 return ExprError();
1181
1182 assert(!R.empty() &&
1183 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001184
1185 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1186 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001187 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001188 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1189 R.clear();
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001190 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001191 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1192 return move(E);
1193 }
Steve Naroff92e30f82007-04-02 22:35:25 +00001194 }
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001195 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001196
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001197 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1198 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1199
1200 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001201 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianc15dfd82010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001202 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1203 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001204 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property =
1205 OkToSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, II, NameLoc);
1206 if (Property) {
1207 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1208 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanian18d90a92010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001209 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian86151342010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001210 }
1211 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001212 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001213 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1214 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1215 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1216 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1217 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1218 // type.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001219 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001220 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001221
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001222 QualType T = Func->getType();
1223 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001224 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedmanb41ad0f2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001225 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1226 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001227 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001228 }
1229 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001230
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001231 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCall24d18942010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001232 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1233 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1234 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1235 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1236 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1237 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1238 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1239 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001240 //
1241 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1242 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1243 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1244 // non-static member function:
1245 //
1246 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1247 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1248 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1249 // member function call.
1250 //
1251 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1252 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1253 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1254 // instance method.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001255 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001256 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1257 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1258 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1259 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1260 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1261 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1262 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregor1262b062010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001263 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1264 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001265 else
1266 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1267
1268 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001269 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001270 }
1271
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001272 if (TemplateArgs)
1273 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001274
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001275 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1276}
1277
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001278/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001279ExprResult
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001280Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1281 LookupResult &R,
1282 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1283 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1284 case IMA_Instance:
1285 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1286
1287 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1288 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1289 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1290 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1291
1292 case IMA_Mixed:
1293 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1294 case IMA_Unresolved:
1295 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1296
1297 case IMA_Static:
1298 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1299 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1300 if (TemplateArgs)
1301 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1302 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1303
1304 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1305 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1306 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1307 return ExprError();
1308 }
1309
1310 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1311 return ExprError();
1312}
1313
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001314/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1315/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1316/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1317/// this path.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001318ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001319Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001320 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001321 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001322 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001323 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001324
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001325 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregora02bb342010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001326 return ExprError();
1327
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001328 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001329 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1330
1331 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1332 return ExprError();
1333
1334 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001335 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1336 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001337 return ExprError();
1338 }
1339
1340 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1341}
1342
1343/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1344/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1345/// additional lookup.
1346///
1347/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1348/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1349///
1350/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001351ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001352Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnera36ec422010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001353 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001354 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001355 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001356
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001357 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1358 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1359 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1360 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1361 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1362
1363 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1364 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1365 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001366 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001367
1368 bool LookForIvars;
1369 if (Lookup.empty())
1370 LookForIvars = true;
1371 else if (IsClassMethod)
1372 LookForIvars = false;
1373 else
1374 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1375 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian45878032010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001376 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001377 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001378 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001379 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1380 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1381 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1382 if (IsClassMethod)
1383 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1384 << IV->getDeclName());
1385
1386 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1387 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1388 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1389 return ExprError();
1390
1391 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1392 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1393 return ExprError();
1394
1395 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1396 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1397 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1398 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1399
1400 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1401 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1402 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1403 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001404 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001405 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001406 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregora1ed39b2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001407 SelfName, false, false);
1408 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1409 return ExprError();
1410
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001411 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1412 return Owned(new (Context)
1413 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1414 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1415 }
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001416 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001417 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattner87313662010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001418 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001419 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1420 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1421 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1422 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1423 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1424 }
1425 }
1426
Fariborz Jahanian6fada5b2010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001427 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1428 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1429 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1430 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1431 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1432 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1433 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1434 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1435 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1436 }
1437 }
1438 }
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001439 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1440 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001441}
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001442
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001443/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1444///
1445/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1446///
1447/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1448/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1449/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1450/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1451///
1452/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1453/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1454/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1455/// the class declaring the member.
1456///
1457/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1458/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1459/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001460bool
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001461Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1462 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001463 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001464 NamedDecl *Member) {
1465 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1466 if (!RD)
1467 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001468
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001469 QualType DestRecordType;
1470 QualType DestType;
1471 QualType FromRecordType;
1472 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1473 bool PointerConversions = false;
1474 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1475 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001476
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001477 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1478 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1479 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1480 PointerConversions = true;
1481 } else {
1482 DestType = DestRecordType;
1483 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001484 }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001485 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1486 if (Method->isStatic())
1487 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001488
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001489 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1490 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001491
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001492 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1493 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1494 PointerConversions = true;
1495 } else {
1496 FromRecordType = FromType;
1497 DestType = DestRecordType;
1498 }
1499 } else {
1500 // No conversion necessary.
1501 return false;
1502 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001503
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001504 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1505 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001506
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001507 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1508 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1509 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001510
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001511 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1512 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1513
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001514 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redlc57d34b2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001515
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001516 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001517 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001518 // class name.
1519 //
1520 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1521 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1522 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1523 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1524 //
1525 // class Base { public: int x; };
1526 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1527 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1528 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1529 //
1530 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1531 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1532 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1533 // }
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001534 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001535 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1536 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1537 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1538
1539 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1540
1541 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1542 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1543 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1544 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001545 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001546 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001547 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001548 return true;
1549
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001550 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001551 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001552 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1553 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001554
1555 FromType = QType;
1556 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1557
1558 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1559 // we're done.
1560 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1561 return false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001562 }
1563 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001564
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001565 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001566
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001567 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1568 // down to the using declaration's type.
1569 //
1570 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1571 // class ever has member declarations.
1572 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1573 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1574 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1575 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1576
1577 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1578 // conversion is non-trivial.
1579 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1580 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001581 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001582 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001583 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001584 return true;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001585
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001586 QualType UType = URecordType;
1587 if (PointerConversions)
1588 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001589 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001590 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001591 FromType = UType;
1592 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1593 }
1594
1595 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1596 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1597 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001598 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001599
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001600 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssonb78feca2010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001601 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1602 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001603 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregorcc3f3252010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001604 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001605
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001606 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall2536c6d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001607 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanian3f150832009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001608 return false;
Fariborz Jahanianbb67b822009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001609}
Douglas Gregor3256d042009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001610
Douglas Gregorf405d7e2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001611/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001612static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedman2cfcef62009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001613 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001614 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001615 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1616 QualType Ty,
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001617 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1618 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1619 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001620 if (SS.isSet()) {
1621 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1622 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001623 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001624
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001625 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001626 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1627 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorc1905232009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001628}
1629
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001630/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1631/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1632/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1633/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001634ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001635Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1636 LookupResult &R,
1637 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1638 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001639 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1640
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001641 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001642
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001643 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1644 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregor6493d9c2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001645 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001646 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001647 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregor9ac7a072009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001648 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001649 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001650
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001651 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1652 // 'this' expression now.
John McCall87fe5d52010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001653 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1654 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001655 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1656 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001657 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1658 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1659 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1660 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001661 }
1662
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001663 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001664 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1665 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001666 SS,
1667 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1668 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001669}
1670
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001671bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001672 const LookupResult &R,
1673 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001674 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1675 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1676 return false;
1677
1678 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001679 if (SS.isSet())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001680 return false;
1681
1682 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001683 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001684 return false;
1685
1686 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1687 // normal lookup:
1688 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1689 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1690
1691 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1692 // -- a declaration of a class member
1693 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1694 // original decl.
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001695 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001696 return false;
1697
1698 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1699 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1700 // using-declaration
1701 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1702 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1703 // turn off ADL anyway).
1704 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
1705 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
1706 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
1707 return false;
1708
1709 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1710 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
1711 // template
1712 // And also for builtin functions.
1713 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
1714 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
1715
1716 // But also builtin functions.
1717 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
1718 return false;
1719 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
1720 return false;
1721 }
1722
1723 return true;
1724}
1725
1726
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001727/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
1728/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
1729/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
1730/// will in fact be used.
1731static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
1732 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
1733 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
1734 return true;
1735 }
1736
1737 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
1738 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
1739 return true;
1740 }
1741
1742 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
1743 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
1744 return true;
1745 }
1746
1747 return false;
1748}
1749
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001750ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001751Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001752 LookupResult &R,
1753 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCall3a60c872009-12-08 22:45:53 +00001754 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
1755 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor4b4844f2010-01-29 17:15:43 +00001756 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001757 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
1758 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001759
1760 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
1761 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
1762 // functions and function templates.
John McCallb53bbd42009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001763 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
1764 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001765 return ExprError();
1766
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001767 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
1768 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
1769 // we've picked a target.
1770 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1771
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001772 bool Dependent
1773 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001774 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00001775 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001776 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001777 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00001778 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
1779 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001780
1781 return Owned(ULE);
1782}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001783
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001784
1785/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001786ExprResult
John McCalle66edc12009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001787Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001788 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
1789 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001790 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall283b9012009-11-22 00:44:51 +00001791 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
1792 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001793
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001794 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001795 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
1796 return ExprError();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00001797
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001798 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
1799 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
1800 // a template argument list.
1801 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
1802 << Template << SS.getRange();
1803 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
1804 return ExprError();
1805 }
1806
1807 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
1808 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
1809 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001810 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001811 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCallb48971d2009-12-18 18:35:10 +00001812 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregore7488b92009-12-01 16:58:18 +00001813 return ExprError();
1814 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001815
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001816 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
1817 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
1818 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
1819 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001820 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001821 return ExprError();
1822
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001823 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
1824 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001825 return ExprError();
1826
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001827 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
1828 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
1829 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
1830 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00001831 //
Chris Lattner2a9d9892008-10-20 05:16:36 +00001832 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
1833 // as they do not get snapshotted.
1834 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001835 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00001836 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump7dafa0d2010-01-05 02:56:35 +00001837 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
1838 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
1839 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1840 return ExprError();
1841 }
1842
Fariborz Jahanianfa24e102010-03-16 23:39:51 +00001843 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump8971a862010-01-05 03:10:36 +00001844 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
1845 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
1846 return ExprError();
1847 }
1848
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00001849 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001850 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001851 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00001852 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001853 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00001854 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
1855 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001856 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001857
Eli Friedman7fa3faa2009-03-22 23:00:19 +00001858 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian70c0b082010-07-12 17:26:57 +00001859 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001860 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
1861 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanianc289bce2010-07-12 18:12:03 +00001862 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001863 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1864 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
1865 Expr *E = new (Context)
1866 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
1867 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001868
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001869 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001870 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian28ed9272010-06-07 16:14:00 +00001871 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001872 SourceLocation(),
1873 Owned(E));
1874 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001875 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
Fariborz Jahanian4239aa12010-07-09 22:21:32 +00001876 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
1877 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
1878 }
Fariborz Jahanianea882cd2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00001879 }
1880 }
1881 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00001882 }
1883 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
1884 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00001885
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001886 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
1887 NameInfo, &SS);
Chris Lattner17ed4872006-11-20 04:58:19 +00001888}
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001889
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001890ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001891 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001892 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001893
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001894 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001895 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattner6307f192008-08-10 01:53:14 +00001896 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
1897 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
1898 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001899 }
Chris Lattner317e6ba2008-01-12 18:39:25 +00001900
Chris Lattnera81a0272008-01-12 08:14:25 +00001901 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
1902 // string.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001903
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001904 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian94627442010-07-23 21:53:24 +00001905 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
1906 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001907 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001908 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson2fb08242009-09-08 18:24:21 +00001909 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerf45c5ec2008-12-12 05:05:20 +00001910 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001911
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001912 QualType ResTy;
1913 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
1914 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
1915 } else {
Anders Carlsson5bd8d192010-02-11 18:20:28 +00001916 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001917
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001918 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00001919 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson0b209a82009-09-11 01:22:35 +00001920 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
1921 }
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00001922 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00001923}
1924
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001925ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001926 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001927 bool Invalid = false;
1928 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
1929 if (Invalid)
1930 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001931
Benjamin Kramer0a1abd42010-02-27 13:44:12 +00001932 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
1933 PP);
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001934 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001935 return ExprError();
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001936
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001937 QualType Ty;
1938 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
1939 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
1940 else if (Literal.isWide())
1941 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedmaneb1df702010-02-03 18:21:45 +00001942 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
1943 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001944 else
1945 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattneref24b382008-03-01 08:32:21 +00001946
Sebastian Redl20614a72009-01-20 22:23:13 +00001947 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
1948 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnerc3847ba2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00001949 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00001950}
1951
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001952ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001953 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001954 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
1955 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner9240b3e2009-01-26 22:36:52 +00001956 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattnerc4c18192009-01-16 07:10:29 +00001957 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00001958 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff5faaef72009-01-20 19:53:53 +00001959 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001960 }
Ted Kremeneke9814182009-01-13 23:19:12 +00001961
Chris Lattner23b7eb62007-06-15 23:05:46 +00001962 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattnera1cf5f92008-09-30 20:53:45 +00001963 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
1964 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Steve Naroff8160ea22007-03-06 01:09:46 +00001965 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001966
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00001967 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregordc970f02010-03-16 22:30:13 +00001968 bool Invalid = false;
1969 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
1970 if (Invalid)
1971 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001972
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001973 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Steve Naroff451d8f162007-03-12 23:22:38 +00001974 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
Steve Narofff2fb89e2007-03-13 20:29:44 +00001975 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001976 return ExprError();
1977
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001978 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001979
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00001980 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001981 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001982 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001983 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001984 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattnerec0a6d92007-09-22 18:29:59 +00001985 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001986 else
Chris Lattner7570e9c2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00001987 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattner9a8d1d92008-06-30 18:32:54 +00001988
1989 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
1990
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00001991 using llvm::APFloat;
1992 APFloat Val(Format);
1993
1994 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall122c8312009-12-24 11:09:08 +00001995
1996 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
1997 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
1998 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
1999 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002000 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002001 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002002 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002003 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002004 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2005 } else {
John McCall62abc942010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002006 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall53b93a02009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002007 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2008 }
2009
2010 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2011 << Ty
2012 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2013 }
2014
2015 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002016 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002017
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002018 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002019 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002020 } else {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002021 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002022
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002023 // long long is a C99 feature.
2024 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth4a1ee052007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002025 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothac582c52007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002026 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2027
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002028 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002029 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002030
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002031 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2032 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2033 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002034 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2035 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002036 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002037 } else {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002038 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2039 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002040
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002041 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2042 // be an unsigned int.
2043 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2044
2045 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002046 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner7b939cf2007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002047 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2048 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002049 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002050
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002051 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2052 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2053 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2054 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002055 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002056 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002057 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002058 Width = IntSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002059 }
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002060 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002061
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002062 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002063 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002064 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002065
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002066 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2067 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2068 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2069 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002070 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002071 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002072 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002073 Width = LongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002074 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002075 }
2076
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002077 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002078 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002079 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002080
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002081 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2082 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2083 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2084 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002085 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002086 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002087 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002088 Width = LongLongSize;
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002089 }
2090 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002091
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002092 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2093 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002094 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002095 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002096 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002097 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Chris Lattner67ca9252007-05-21 01:08:44 +00002098 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002099
Chris Lattner55258cf2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002100 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2101 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002102 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis43b20572010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002103 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Steve Naroff09ef4742007-03-09 23:16:33 +00002104 }
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002105
Chris Lattner1c20a172007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002106 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2107 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002108 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002109 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlffbcf962009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002110
2111 return Owned(Res);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002112}
2113
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002114ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002115 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002116 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002117 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002118}
2119
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00002120/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00002121/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002122bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002123 SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002124 SourceRange ExprRange,
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002125 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002126 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2127 return false;
2128
Sebastian Redl22e2e5c2009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002129 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2130 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2131 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2132 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2133 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2134 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2135
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002136 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002137 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002138 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002139 if (isSizeof)
2140 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2141 return false;
2142 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002143
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002144 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002145 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002146 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2147 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattnerb1355b12009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002148 return false;
2149 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002150
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002151 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002152 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2153 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002154 return true;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002155
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002156 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002157 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002158 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattnercd2a8c52009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002159 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2160 return true;
Chris Lattner37920f52009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002161 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002162
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002163 return false;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002164}
2165
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002166static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2167 SourceRange ExprRange) {
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002168 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002169
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002170 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002171 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2172 return false;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002173
2174 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2175 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2176 return false;
2177
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002178 if (E->getBitField()) {
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002179 S. Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002180 return true;
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002181 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002182
2183 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2184 // bit-field.
2185 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump212005c2009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002186 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002187 return false;
2188
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002189 return S.CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
Chris Lattner8dff0172009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002190}
2191
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002192/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002193ExprResult
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002194Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002195 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002196 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002197 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002198 return ExprError();
2199
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002200 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall4c98fd82009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002201
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002202 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2203 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2204 return ExprError();
2205
2206 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002207 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002208 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2209 R.getEnd()));
2210}
2211
2212/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2213/// operand.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002214ExprResult
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002215Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002216 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2217 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2218 bool isInvalid = false;
2219 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2220 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2221 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002222 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002223 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002224 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2225 isInvalid = true;
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002226 } else if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
2227 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E, OpLoc);
2228 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2229 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(PE.take(), OpLoc, isSizeOf, R);
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002230 } else {
2231 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2232 }
2233
2234 if (isInvalid)
2235 return ExprError();
2236
2237 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2238 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2239 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2240 R.getEnd()));
2241}
2242
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002243/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2244/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2245/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002246ExprResult
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002247Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2248 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Chris Lattner0d8b1a12006-11-20 04:34:45 +00002249 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002250 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00002251
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002252 if (isType) {
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002253 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002254 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCallbcd03502009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002255 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002256 }
Sebastian Redl6f282892008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002257
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002258 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002259 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002260 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2261
Douglas Gregor0950e412009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002262 return move(Result);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002263}
2264
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002265QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002266 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2267 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002268
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002269 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002270 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002271 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002272
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002273 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2274 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2275 return V->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002276
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002277 // Test for placeholders.
2278 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(V, Loc);
2279 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
2280 if (PR.take() != V) {
2281 V = PR.take();
2282 return CheckRealImagOperand(V, Loc, isReal);
2283 }
2284
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002285 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattner709322b2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002286 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2287 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnere267f5d2007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002288 return QualType();
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002289}
2290
2291
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002292
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002293ExprResult
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002294Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002295 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002296 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002297 switch (Kind) {
2298 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002299 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2300 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002301 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002302
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002303 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002304}
2305
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002306ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002307Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2308 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002309 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002310 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002311 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2312 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002313
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002314 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002315
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002316 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002317 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor7a77a6b2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002318 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2319 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2320 }
2321
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002322 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002323 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman254a1a22008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002324 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2325 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2326 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002327 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor40412ac2008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002328 }
2329
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002330 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002331}
2332
2333
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002334ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002335Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2336 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2337 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2338 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redladba46e2009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002339
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002340 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002341 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2342 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2343 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002344
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002345 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002346
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002347 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002348 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002349 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Steve Narofff1e53692007-03-23 22:27:02 +00002350 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002351 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2352 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002353 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2354 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2355 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2356 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002357 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002358 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2359 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002360 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002361 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattneraee0cfd2007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002362 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002363 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2364 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002365 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002366 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002367 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002368 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2369 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2370 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002371 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002372 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002373 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2374 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2375 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2376 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002377 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattner41977962007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002378 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002379 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begemanc1bf0612009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002380
Chris Lattner36d572b2007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002381 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2382 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002383 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2384 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002385 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002386 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2387 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2388 // force the promotion here.
2389 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2390 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002391 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002392 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002393 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2394
2395 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2396 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002397 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002398 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2399 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2400 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2401 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002402 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002403 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedmanab2784f2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002404 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2405
2406 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2407 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002408 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroffb3096442007-06-09 03:47:53 +00002409 } else {
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002410 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2411 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002412 }
Steve Naroffc1aadb12007-03-28 21:49:40 +00002413 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002414 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner003af242009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002415 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2416 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffb29cdd52007-07-10 18:23:31 +00002417
Daniel Dunbar4782a6e2009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002418 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinigb7608d72009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002419 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2420 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig914244e2009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002421 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2422
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002423 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002424 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2425 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002426 // incomplete types are not object types.
2427 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2428 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2429 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2430 return ExprError();
2431 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002432
Abramo Bagnara3aabb4b2010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002433 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2434 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2435 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2436 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2437 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002438 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002439 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2440 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002441 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002442
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002443 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002444 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner62975a72009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002445 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2446 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2447 return ExprError();
2448 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002449
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002450 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002451 ResultType, RLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00002452}
2453
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002454QualType Sema::
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002455CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002456 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002457 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbarc0429402009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002458 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2459 // see FIXME there.
2460 //
2461 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2462 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002463 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002464
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002465 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002466 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002467
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002468 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002469 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2470 // to be selected.
2471 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002472
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002473 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2474 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman0359e122009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002475 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002476
2477 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2478 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002479 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002480 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2481 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002482 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002483 do
2484 compStr++;
2485 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002486 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002487 do
2488 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002489 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner7e152db2007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002490 }
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002491
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002492 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002493 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2494 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002495 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramere8394df2010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002496 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002497 return QualType();
2498 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002499
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002500 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2501 // operates on.
2502 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbar2c422dc92009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002503 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002504
2505 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002506 compStr++;
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002507
2508 while (*compStr) {
2509 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2510 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2511 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2512 return QualType();
2513 }
2514 }
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002515 }
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002516
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002517 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002518 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002519 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002520 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begemanf322eab2008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002521 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begemanac8183a2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002522 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002523 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begemanbb70bf62009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002524 if (HexSwizzle)
2525 CompSize--;
2526
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002527 if (CompSize == 1)
2528 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002529
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002530 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002531 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begemance4d7fc2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002532 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2533 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2534 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2535 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffddf5a1d2007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002536 }
2537 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Narofff8fd09e2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002538}
2539
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002540static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002541 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregorbcced4e2009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002542 const Selector &Sel,
2543 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002544 if (Member)
2545 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
2546 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002547 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002548 return OMD;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002549
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002550 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2551 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002552 if (Decl *D = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2553 Context))
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002554 return D;
2555 }
2556 return 0;
2557}
2558
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002559static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
2560 IdentifierInfo *Member,
2561 const Selector &Sel,
2562 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002563 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2564 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002565 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002566 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002567 if (Member)
2568 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
2569 GDecl = PD;
2570 break;
2571 }
2572 // Also must look for a getter or setter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002573 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002574 GDecl = OMD;
2575 break;
2576 }
2577 }
2578 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Narofffb4330f2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002579 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002580 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2581 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002582 GDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2583 Context);
Fariborz Jahaniand302bbd02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002584 if (GDecl)
2585 return GDecl;
2586 }
2587 }
2588 return GDecl;
2589}
Chris Lattner4bf74fd2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002590
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002591ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002592Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002593 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002594 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2595 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002596 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002597 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002598 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2599 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2600 //
2601 // T* t;
2602 // t.f;
2603 //
2604 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2605 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2606 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2607 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002608 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002609 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2610 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002611 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002612 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002613 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002614 return ExprError();
2615 }
2616 }
2617
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002618 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2619 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002620 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002621
2622 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2623 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002624 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002625 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002626 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002627 SS.getRange(),
2628 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002629 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002630}
2631
2632/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2633/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2634/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2635static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2636 Expr *BaseExpr,
2637 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002638 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002639 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002640 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2641 // diagnostics.
2642 if (!BaseExpr)
2643 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002644
John McCall1e67dd62010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002645 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2646 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002647}
2648
2649// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2650// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2651// type. The restriction here is:
2652//
2653// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2654// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2655// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2656//
2657// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2658// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2659// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2660// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2661bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2662 QualType BaseType,
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002663 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002664 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002665 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2666 if (!BaseRT) {
2667 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2668 // dependent.
2669 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2670 return false;
2671 }
2672 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002673
2674 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002675 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2676 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002677 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002678 return false;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002679
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002680 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002681 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2682 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2683 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002684
Douglas Gregora9c3e822010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002685 if (!DC->isRecord())
2686 continue;
2687
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002688 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman75300492010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002689 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002690
2691 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2692 return false;
2693 }
2694
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002695 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002696 return true;
2697}
2698
2699static bool
2700LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2701 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002702 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2703 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002704 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
2705 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00002706 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002707 << BaseRange))
2708 return true;
2709
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002710 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
2711 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
2712 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
2713
2714 bool MOUS;
2715 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
2716 return false;
2717 }
2718
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002719 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
2720 if (SS.isSet()) {
2721 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
2722 // nested-name-specifier.
2723 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
2724
John McCall0b66eb32010-05-01 00:40:08 +00002725 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002726 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
2727 << SS.getRange() << DC;
2728 return true;
2729 }
2730
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002731 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002732
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002733 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
2734 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
2735 << DC << SS.getRange();
2736 return true;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002737 }
2738 }
2739
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002740 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
2741 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002742
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002743 if (!R.empty())
2744 return false;
2745
2746 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
2747 // for typos.
2748 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00002749 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00002750 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002751 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
2752 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
2753 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00002754 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
2755 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00002756 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
2757 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
2758 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002759 return false;
2760 } else {
2761 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00002762 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregoraf2bd472009-12-31 07:42:17 +00002763 }
2764
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002765 return false;
2766}
2767
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002768ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002769Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002770 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00002771 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002772 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002773 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002774 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCallcd4b4772009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002775 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2776 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002777 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002778 IsArrow, OpLoc,
2779 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002780 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002781
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002782 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002783
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002784 // Implicit member accesses.
2785 if (!Base) {
2786 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
2787 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2788 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
2789 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00002790 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002791 return ExprError();
2792
2793 // Explicit member accesses.
2794 } else {
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002795 ExprResult Result =
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002796 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00002797 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002798
2799 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
2800 Owned(Base);
2801 return ExprError();
2802 }
2803
2804 if (Result.get())
2805 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlfa1f70f2010-05-07 09:25:11 +00002806
2807 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
2808 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002809 }
2810
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002811 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002812 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
2813 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002814}
2815
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002816ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002817Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002818 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
2819 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002820 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002821 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002822 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
2823 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002824 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002825 if (IsArrow) {
2826 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
2827 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
2828 }
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002829 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002830
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002831 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002832 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
2833 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
2834 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002835
2836 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregord8061562009-08-06 03:17:00 +00002837 return ExprError();
2838
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002839 if (R.empty()) {
2840 // Rederive where we looked up.
2841 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
2842 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
2843 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002844
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002845 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002846 << MemberName << DC
2847 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002848 return ExprError();
2849 }
2850
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002851 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
2852 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
2853 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
2854 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
2855 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
2856 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
2857 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
2858 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
2859 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
2860 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregorb139cd52010-05-01 20:49:11 +00002861 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00002862 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002863 return ExprError();
2864
2865 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
2866 // result.
2867 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002868 bool Dependent =
John McCall71739032009-12-19 02:05:44 +00002869 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002870 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall1acbbb52010-02-02 06:20:04 +00002871 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002872
John McCall58cc69d2010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002873 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
2874 // pick a member.
2875 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2876
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002877 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
2878 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
2879 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002880 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
2881 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002882 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002883 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor30a4f4c2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002884 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002885
2886 return Owned(MemExpr);
2887 }
2888
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002889 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002890 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002891 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
2892
2893 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
2894
2895 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
2896 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
2897 // error cases.
2898 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
2899 return ExprError();
2900
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002901 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
2902 if (!BaseExpr) {
2903 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCalla8ae2222010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002904 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002905 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002906
Douglas Gregorb15af892010-01-07 23:12:05 +00002907 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
2908 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
2909 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
2910 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002911 }
2912
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002913 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
2914 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2915 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
2916 // explicitly qualified.
2917 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
2918 ShouldCheckUse = false;
2919 }
2920
2921 // Check the use of this member.
2922 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
2923 Owned(BaseExpr);
2924 return ExprError();
2925 }
2926
2927 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2928 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
2929 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman78cde142009-12-04 07:18:51 +00002930 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
2931 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002932 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
2933 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
2934
2935 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
2936 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
2937 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2938 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2939 else {
2940 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
2941 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
2942 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
2943
2944 Qualifiers MemberQuals
2945 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
2946
2947 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
2948 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
2949 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
2950 }
2951
2952 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall16df1e52010-03-30 21:47:33 +00002953 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002954 return ExprError();
2955 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002956 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2957 MemberType));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002958 }
2959
2960 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2961 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
2962 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002963 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002964 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
2965 }
2966
2967 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2968 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2969 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002970 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002971 MemberFn->getType()));
2972 }
2973
2974 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
2975 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
2976 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002977 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
2978 Enum->getType()));
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002979 }
2980
2981 Owned(BaseExpr);
2982
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002983 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002984 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002985 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002986 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
2987 else
2988 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
2989 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002990
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002991 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
2992 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00002993 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregor861eb802010-04-25 20:55:08 +00002994 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002995}
2996
2997/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
2998/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
2999/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
3000/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
3001/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
3002/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
3003/// an ordinary member expression.
3004///
3005/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
3006/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003007ExprResult
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003008Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003009 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003010 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003011 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003012 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003013
Steve Naroffeaaae462007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003014 // Perform default conversions.
3015 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003016
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003017 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003018 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3019
3020 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3021 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003022
3023 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003024 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003025 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3026 // call, and continue on.
3027 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3028 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3029 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3030 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3031 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003032 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3033 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003034 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3035 ->isRecordType()))) {
3036 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
3037 Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
3038 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003039 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003040
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003041 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003042 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregor143d3672010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003043 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003044 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003045 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003046
Douglas Gregord82ae382009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003047 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3048 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3049 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3050 }
3051 }
3052 }
3053
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003054 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3055 // use that.
3056 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003057 if (IsArrow) {
3058 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3059 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3060 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003061 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003062 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003063 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3064 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanianc2949f92009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003065 }
3066 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003067 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3068 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3069 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3070 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003071 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003072 }
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003073 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003074
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003075 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3076 // use that.
3077 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3078 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3079 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3080 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3081 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003082 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian04b258c2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003083 }
3084 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003085
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003086 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003087
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003088 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003089 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003090 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3091 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3092 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3093 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3094 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3095 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3096 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3097 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3098 // Check the use of this method.
3099 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3100 return ExprError();
3101 }
3102 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3103 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3104 Selector SetterSel =
3105 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3106 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3107 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3108 if (!Setter) {
3109 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3110 // methods.
Steve Naroffbb69c942009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003111 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003112 }
3113 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3114 if (!Setter)
3115 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003116
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003117 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3118 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003119
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003120 if (Getter || Setter) {
3121 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003122
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003123 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003124 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003125 else
3126 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3127 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3128 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003129 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003130 PType,
3131 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3132 }
3133 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3134 << MemberName << BaseType);
3135 }
3136 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003137
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003138 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3139 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3140 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003141 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniane983d172009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003142 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003143
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003144 if (IsArrow) {
3145 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroff185616f2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003146 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003147 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3148 ;
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003149 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3150 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3151 // struct MyRecord foo;
3152 // foo->bar
3153 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3154 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3155 // by now.
3156 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3157 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003158 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003159 IsArrow = false;
3160 } else {
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003161 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3162 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3163 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson524d5a42009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003164 }
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003165 } else {
3166 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3167 // type *foo;
3168 // foo.bar
3169 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3170 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3171 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3172 // the appropriate pointer type
3173 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3174 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3175 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3176 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3177 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003178 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCalla928c652009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003179 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3180 IsArrow = true;
3181 }
3182 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003183 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003184
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003185 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003186 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003187 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003188 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003189 return ExprError();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003190 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003191 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003192
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003193 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3194 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003195 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003196 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003197 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003198 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3199 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3200 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3201 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003202 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3203
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003204 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003205 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003206
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003207 if (!IV) {
3208 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3209 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3210 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor280e1ee2010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003211 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false, CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003212 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003213 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003214 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3215 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003216 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3217 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor6da83622010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003218 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003219 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregorc048c522010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003220 } else {
3221 Res.clear();
3222 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregor35b0bac2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003223 }
3224 }
3225
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003226 if (IV) {
3227 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3228 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3229 // error cases.
3230 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3231 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor171c45a2009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003232
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003233 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3234 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3235 return ExprError();
3236 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3237 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3238 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3239 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3240 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3241 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3242 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3243 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3244 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3245 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3246 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3247 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003248 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003249 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003250 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3251 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003252 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003253 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3254 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003255
3256 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3257 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003258 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003259 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003260 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003261 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3262 // @protected
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003263 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003264 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffd1b64be2009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003265 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003266
3267 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3268 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003269 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahaniana458c4f2009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003270 }
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003271 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003272 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffa057ba92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003273 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianb1378f92008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003274 }
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003275 }
Steve Naroff1329fa02009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003276 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003277 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3278 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003279 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003280 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003281
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003282 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003283 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003284 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel,
3285 Context)) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003286 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3287 // Check the use of this declaration
3288 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3289 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003290
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003291 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
3292 MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3293 }
3294 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3295 // Check the use of this method.
3296 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3297 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanianf3f903a2010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003298 Selector SetterSel =
3299 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3300 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3301 ObjCMethodDecl *SMD = 0;
3302 if (Decl *SDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, /*Property id*/0,
3303 SetterSel, Context))
3304 SMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(SDecl);
3305 QualType PType = OMD->getSendResultType();
3306 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(OMD, PType,
3307 SMD,
3308 MemberLoc,
3309 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003310 }
3311 }
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003312
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003313 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003314 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003315 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003316
Chris Lattnerdc420f42008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003317 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3318 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner2b1ca5f2010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003319 if (!IsArrow)
3320 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3321 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Chris Lattner90c58fa2010-04-11 07:51:10 +00003322 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003323
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003324 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003325 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003326 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3327 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003328 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003329 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahaniana5fee262009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003330 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Naroffe87026a2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003331
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003332 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner6c7ce102009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003333 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003334 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003335 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3336 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003337 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003338 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003339 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerb63a7452008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003340 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003341
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003342 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3343 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3344
Douglas Gregor0b08ba42009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003345 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003346}
3347
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003348/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3349/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3350/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3351/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3352/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3353///
3354/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3355/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3356/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3357/// only be called
3358/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3359/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3360/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003361ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003362 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3363 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskinc76498d2010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003364 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003365 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCall48871652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003366 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003367 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3368 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3369 return ExprError();
3370
3371 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3372
3373 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003374 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003375 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3376 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003377 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003378
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003379 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003380 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3381
3382 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3383 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3384 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3385
3386 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003387 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003388 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3389 Base = Result.take();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003390
Douglas Gregor41f90302010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003391 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3392 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003393 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003394 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3395 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003396 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003397 } else {
Abramo Bagnarad6d2f182010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003398 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003399 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3400 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003401
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003402 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3403 Owned(Base);
3404 return ExprError();
3405 }
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003406
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003407 if (Result.get()) {
3408 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3409 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3410 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3411 // call now.
3412 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3413 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003414 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003415
John McCalle9cccd82010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003416 return move(Result);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003417 }
3418
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003419 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall38836f02010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003420 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3421 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003422 }
3423
3424 return move(Result);
Anders Carlssonf571c112009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003425}
3426
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003427ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003428 FunctionDecl *FD,
3429 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3430 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003431 Diag(CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003432 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3433 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003434 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003435 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003436 return ExprError();
3437 }
3438
3439 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3440 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003441
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003442 // Instantiate the expression.
3443 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3444 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson657bad42009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003445
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003446 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3447 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3448 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3449 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003450
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003451 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3452 if (Result.isInvalid())
3453 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003454
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003455 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3456 InitializedEntity Entity
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003457 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003458 InitializationKind Kind
3459 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3460 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3461 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor25ab25f2009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003462
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003463 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3464 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3465 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3466 if (Result.isInvalid())
3467 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003468
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003469 // Build the default argument expression.
3470 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3471 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003472 }
3473
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003474 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3475 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3476 // be properly destroyed.
3477 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3478 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor6ed2fee2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003479 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3480 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3481 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3482 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3483 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
3484 }
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003485
3486 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003487 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3488 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003489 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor033f6752009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003490 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003491}
3492
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003493/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3494/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3495/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3496/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3497/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3498/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003499bool
3500Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003501 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003502 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003503 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3504 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003505 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003506 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3507 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003508 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003509
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003510 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3511 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3512 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3513 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3514 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003515 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherabf1e182010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003516 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003517 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003518 }
3519
3520 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3521 // them.
3522 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3523 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3524 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3525 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003526 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopher2a5aaff2010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003527 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003528 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3529 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3530 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek5a201952009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003531 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003532 return true;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003533 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003534 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003535 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003536 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003537 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3538 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3539 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3540 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3541 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003542 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian4fa66ce2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003543 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003544 if (Invalid)
3545 return true;
3546 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3547 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3548 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003549
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003550 return false;
3551}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003552
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003553bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3554 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3555 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3556 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3557 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3558 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003559 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003560 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3561 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3562 bool Invalid = false;
3563 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3564 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3565 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3566 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003567 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003568 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003569 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003570
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003571 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003572 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3573 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003574
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003575 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3576 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003577 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003578 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003579 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003580
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003581 // Pass the argument
3582 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3583 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3584 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregor96596c92009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003585
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003586 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003587 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param)
3588 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, ProtoArgType);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003589 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregorbbeb5c32009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003590 SourceLocation(),
3591 Owned(Arg));
3592 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3593 return true;
3594
3595 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003596 } else {
Anders Carlssonc80a1272009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003597 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003598
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003599 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003600 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003601 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3602 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003603
Anders Carlsson355933d2009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003604 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson84613c42009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003605 }
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003606 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003607 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003608
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003609 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian6f2d25e2009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003610 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003611 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003612 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003613 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattnerbb53efb2010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003614 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian835026e2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003615 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003616 }
3617 }
Douglas Gregorb6b99612009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003618 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003619}
3620
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003621/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003622/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3623/// locations.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003624ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003625Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003626 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003627 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003628
3629 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003630 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003631 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3632 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003633
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003634 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003635
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003636 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003637 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3638 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3639 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3640 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3641 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003642 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003643 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3644 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003645
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003646 NumArgs = 0;
3647 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003648
Douglas Gregorad8a3362009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003649 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3650 RParenLoc));
3651 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003652
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003653 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003654 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003655 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3656 // Fn.
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003657 bool Dependent = false;
3658 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3659 Dependent = true;
3660 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3661 Dependent = true;
3662
3663 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenekd7b4f402009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003664 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003665 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3666
3667 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3668 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3669 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003670 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregorb8a9a412009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003671
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003672 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3673
3674 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3675 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3676 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3677 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3678 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3679 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3680 // method template.
3681 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor516d6722010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003682 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3683 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor8f184a32009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003684 (void)MemE;
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003685
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003686 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003687 RParenLoc);
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003688 }
3689
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003690 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003691 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003692 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003693 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003694 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003695 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregorad3f2fc2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003696 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003697
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003698 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall10eae182009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003699 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003700 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
3701 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregorc8be9522010-05-04 18:18:31 +00003702 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
3703 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003704 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003705
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003706 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
3707 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
3708 NumArgs, ResultTy,
3709 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003710
3711 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
3712 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003713 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003714 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson63dce022009-10-15 00:41:48 +00003715
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003716 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003717 RParenLoc))
3718 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003719
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003720 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003721 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003722 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian42f66632009-10-28 16:49:46 +00003723 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3724 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson61914b52009-10-03 17:40:22 +00003725 }
3726 }
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003727 }
3728
Douglas Gregore254f902009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003729 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003730 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor89026b52009-06-30 23:57:56 +00003731 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003732
Eli Friedmane14b1992009-12-26 03:35:45 +00003733 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003734 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3735 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
Douglas Gregor2fb18b72010-04-14 20:27:54 +00003736 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregorce5aa332010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003737 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00003738 }
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003739
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003740 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
3741 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
3742 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
3743
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003744 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
3745}
3746
John McCall57500772009-12-16 12:17:52 +00003747/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
3748/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003749/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
3750/// block-pointer type.
3751///
3752/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003753ExprResult
John McCall2d74de92009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003754Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
3755 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
3756 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3757 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
3758 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
3759
Chris Lattneraa9c7ae2008-04-08 04:40:51 +00003760 // Promote the function operand.
3761 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
3762
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003763 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
3764 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003765 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
3766 Args, NumArgs,
3767 Context.BoolTy,
3768 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003769
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003770 const FunctionType *FuncT;
3771 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
3772 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
3773 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003774 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003775 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003776 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3777 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003778 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003779 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003780 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003781 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroff8de9c3a2008-09-05 22:11:13 +00003782 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003783 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003784 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
3785 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
3786
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003787 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003788 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003789 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00003790 FDecl))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003791 return ExprError();
3792
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003793 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor603d81b2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003794 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003795
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003796 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003797 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003798 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003799 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003800 } else {
Douglas Gregordeaad8c2009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003801 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003802
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003803 if (FDecl) {
3804 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
3805 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
3806 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis36ea3222010-07-07 11:31:19 +00003807 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003808 const FunctionProtoType *Proto =
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003809 Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Eli Friedmanfcbf7d22009-06-01 09:24:59 +00003810 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size())) {
3811 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
3812 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
3813 }
3814 }
Douglas Gregord8e97de2009-04-02 15:37:10 +00003815 }
3816
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003817 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003818 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
3819 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
3820 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003821 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3822 Arg->getType(),
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003823 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
3824 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedman3164fb12009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003825 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003826 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroff0b661582007-08-28 23:30:39 +00003827 }
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00003828 }
Chris Lattner08464942007-12-28 05:29:59 +00003829
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003830 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
3831 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003832 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
3833 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor97fd6e22008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003834
Fariborz Jahanian0aa5c452009-05-15 20:33:25 +00003835 // Check for sentinels
3836 if (NDecl)
3837 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003838
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003839 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003840 if (FDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003841 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003842 return ExprError();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003843
Douglas Gregor15fc9562009-09-12 00:22:50 +00003844 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003845 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003846 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003847 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssonbc4c1072009-08-16 01:56:34 +00003848 return ExprError();
3849 }
Chris Lattnerb87b1b32007-08-10 20:18:51 +00003850
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003851 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00003852}
3853
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003854ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00003855Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003856 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003857 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroff57eb2c52007-07-19 21:32:11 +00003858 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003859 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003860
3861 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
3862 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
3863 if (!TInfo)
3864 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
3865
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003866 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003867}
3868
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003869ExprResult
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003870Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003871 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00003872 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlsson2c1ec6d2007-12-05 07:24:19 +00003873
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003874 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Chris Lattner7adf0762008-08-04 07:31:14 +00003875 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003876 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
3877 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor1c37d9e2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00003878 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
3879 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003880 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003881 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003882 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003883 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman37a186d2008-05-20 05:22:08 +00003884
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003885 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregor1b303932009-12-22 15:35:07 +00003886 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003887 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003888 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor85dabae2009-12-16 01:38:02 +00003889 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003890 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003891 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCall37ad5512010-08-23 06:44:23 +00003892 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003893 &literalType);
3894 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003895 return ExprError();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003896 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003897
Chris Lattner79413952008-12-04 23:50:19 +00003898 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffd32419d2008-01-14 18:19:28 +00003899 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003900 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003901 return ExprError();
Steve Naroff98f72032008-01-10 22:15:12 +00003902 }
Eli Friedmana553d4a2009-12-22 02:35:53 +00003903
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00003904 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003905 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003906}
3907
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003908ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003909Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003910 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
3911 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003912 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson4692db02007-08-31 04:56:16 +00003913
Steve Naroff30d242c2007-09-15 18:49:24 +00003914 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003915 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003916
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00003917 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
3918 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00003919 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00003920 return Owned(E);
Steve Narofffbd09832007-07-19 01:06:55 +00003921}
3922
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003923static CastKind getScalarCastKind(ASTContext &Context,
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003924 QualType SrcTy, QualType DestTy) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003925 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003926 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003927
3928 if (SrcTy->hasPointerRepresentation()) {
3929 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003930 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003931 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
3932 CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003933 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003934 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003935 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003936
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003937 if (SrcTy->isIntegerType()) {
3938 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003939 return CK_IntegralCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003940 if (DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003941 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003942 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003943 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003944 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003945
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003946 if (SrcTy->isRealFloatingType()) {
3947 if (DestTy->isRealFloatingType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003948 return CK_FloatingCast;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003949 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003950 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003951 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003952
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003953 // FIXME: Assert here.
3954 // assert(false && "Unhandled cast combination!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003955 return CK_Unknown;
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00003956}
3957
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003958/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redl955a0672009-07-29 13:50:23 +00003959bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003960 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00003961 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahanian1cec0c42009-08-26 18:55:36 +00003962 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003963 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00003964 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
3965 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9f831db2009-07-25 15:41:38 +00003966
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00003967 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00003968
3969 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
3970 // type needs to be scalar.
3971 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
3972 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003973 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003974 return false;
3975 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003976
Eli Friedmane98194d2010-07-17 20:43:49 +00003977 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
3978 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
3979 return true;
3980
Anders Carlssonef918ac2009-10-16 02:35:04 +00003981 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00003982 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003983 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
3984 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00003985 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003986 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
3987 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003988 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003989 return false;
3990 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003991
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00003992 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003993 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003994 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003995 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00003996 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00003997 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003998 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara5d3e7242010-10-07 21:20:44 +00003999 castExpr->getType()) &&
4000 !Field->isUnnamedBitfield()) {
Seo Sanghyeon39a3ebf2009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004001 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
4002 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4003 break;
4004 }
4005 }
4006 if (Field == FieldEnd)
4007 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
4008 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004009 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004010 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004011 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004012
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004013 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
4014 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4015 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4016 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004017
4018 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004019 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004020 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4021 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004022 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004023 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004024
4025 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004026 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004027
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004028 if (castType->isVectorType())
4029 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4030 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4031 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4032
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004033 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4034 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004035
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004036 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004037 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004038 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregorb90df602010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004039 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004040 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4041 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4042 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4043 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004044 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedmanf4e3ad62009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004045 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4046 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4047 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004048 }
Anders Carlsson094c4592009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004049
4050 Kind = getScalarCastKind(Context, castExpr->getType(), castType);
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004051
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004052 if (Kind == CK_Unknown || Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCall2b5c1b22010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004053 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4054
Argyrios Kyrtzidis2ade3902008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004055 return false;
4056}
4057
Anders Carlsson525b76b2009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004058bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004059 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004060 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004061
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004062 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner37e05872008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004063 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004064 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004065 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004066 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004067 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004068 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004069 } else
4070 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004071 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004072 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004073
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004074 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssonde71adf2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004075 return false;
4076}
4077
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004078bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004079 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004080 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004081
Anders Carlsson43d70f82009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004082 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004083
Nate Begemanc8961a42009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004084 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4085 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004086 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4087 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4088 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4089 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004090 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004091 return false;
4092 }
4093
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004094 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004095 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4096 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004097 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4098 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4099 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4100 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004101
4102 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4103 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
4104 getScalarCastKind(Context, SrcTy, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004105
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004106 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begemanc69b7402009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004107 return false;
4108}
4109
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004110ExprResult
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004111Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004112 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4113 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004114 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff1a2cf6b2007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004115
John McCall97513962010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004116 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4117 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4118 if (!castTInfo)
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004119 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004120
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004121 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4122 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004123 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004124 castTInfo);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004125
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004126 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004127}
4128
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004129ExprResult
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004130Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004131 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004132 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004133 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallebe54742010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004134 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlssona70cff62010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004135 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004136 return ExprError();
Anders Carlssone9766d52009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004137
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004138 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004139 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallcf142162010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004140 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4141 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004142}
4143
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004144/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4145/// of comma binary operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004146ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004147Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004148 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4149 if (!E)
4150 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004151
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004152 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004153
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004154 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004155 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4156 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004157
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004158 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4159
4160 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004161}
4162
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004163ExprResult
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004164Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004165 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004166 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004167 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004168 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004169 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004170
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004171 // Check for an altivec literal,
4172 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004173 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4174 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4175 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4176 return ExprError();
4177 }
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004178 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4179 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4180 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4181 }
4182 else
4183 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4184 }
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004185
John Thompson781ad172010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004186 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4187 // then handle it as such.
4188 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004189 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4190 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4191 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4192
4193 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4194 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004195 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4196 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004197 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4198 E->setType(Ty);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004199 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004200 } else {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004201 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004202 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004203 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004204 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4205 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004206 }
4207}
4208
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004209ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004210 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004211 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004212 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004213 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4214 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanian906d8712009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004215 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4216 Expr *expr;
4217 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4218 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4219 else
4220 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004221 return Owned(expr);
4222}
4223
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004224/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4225/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004226/// C99 6.5.15
4227QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004228 Expr *&SAVE,
Chris Lattner2c486602009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004229 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004230 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4231 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004232 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, SAVE, QuestionLoc);
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004233
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004234 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004235 if (SAVE) {
4236 SAVE = LHS = Cond;
4237 }
4238 else
4239 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004240 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4241 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4242 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4243 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004244
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004245 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl1a99f442009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004246 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
Nate Begemanabb5a732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004247 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4248 // Throw an error if its not either.
4249 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL) {
4250 if (!CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4251 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(),
4252 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4253 << CondTy;
4254 return QualType();
4255 }
4256 }
4257 else {
4258 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4259 << CondTy;
4260 return QualType();
4261 }
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004262 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004263
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004264 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman5ec4b312009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004265 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4266 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor4619e432008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004267
Nate Begemanabb5a732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004268 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4269 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4270 // built in select.
4271 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4272 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4273 if (!LHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4274 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4275 << CondTy;
4276 return QualType();
4277 }
4278 if (!RHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4279 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4280 << CondTy;
4281 return QualType();
4282 }
4283 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
4284 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4285 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4286 }
4287
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004288 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4289 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004290 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4291 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4292 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffdbd9e892007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004293 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004294
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004295 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4296 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004297 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4298 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004299 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004300 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004301 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004302 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004303 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004304 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004305
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004306 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004307 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004308 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4309 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4310 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4311 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4312 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4313 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4314 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004315 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4316 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman3e1852f2008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004317 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffbf1516c2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004318 }
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004319 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4320 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004321 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004322 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004323 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004324 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004325 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004326 }
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004327 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004328 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004329 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004330 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroff039ad3c2008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004331 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004332
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004333 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4334 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4335 QuestionLoc);
4336 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4337 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004338
4339
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004340 // Handle block pointer types.
4341 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4342 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4343 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4344 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004345 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4346 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004347 return destType;
4348 }
4349 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004350 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004351 return QualType();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004352 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004353 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4354 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4355 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004356 return LHSTy;
4357 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004358 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004359 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4360 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004361
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004362 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4363 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004364 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004365 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004366 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4367 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4368 // to get a consistent AST.
4369 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004370 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4371 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004372 return incompatTy;
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004373 }
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004374 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004375 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4376 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroffea4c7802009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004377 return LHSTy;
4378 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004379
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004380 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4381 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4382 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004383 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4384 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004385
4386 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4387 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4388 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004389 QualType destPointee
4390 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004391 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004392 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004393 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004394 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004395 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004396 return destType;
4397 }
4398 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall8ccfcb52009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004399 QualType destPointee
4400 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004401 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004402 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004403 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman06ed2a52009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004404 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004405 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004406 return destType;
4407 }
4408
4409 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4410 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4411 return LHSTy;
4412 }
4413 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4414 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4415 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4416 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4417 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4418 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4419 // to get a consistent AST.
4420 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004421 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4422 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004423 return incompatTy;
4424 }
4425 // The pointer types are compatible.
4426 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4427 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4428 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4429 // type.
4430 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4431 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004432 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4433 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004434 return LHSTy;
4435 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004436
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004437 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch.
4438 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4439 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4440 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004441 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004442 return RHSTy;
4443 }
4444 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4445 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4446 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004447 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff05efa972009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004448 return LHSTy;
4449 }
Daniel Dunbar484603b2008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004450
Chris Lattnere2949f42008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004451 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattner432cff52009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004452 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4453 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00004454 return QualType();
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004455}
4456
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004457/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4458/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4459QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4460 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4461 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4462 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004463
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004464 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4465 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4466 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4467 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4468 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004469 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004470 return LHSTy;
4471 }
4472 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4473 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004474 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004475 return RHSTy;
4476 }
4477 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4478 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4479 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004480 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004481 return LHSTy;
4482 }
4483 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4484 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004485 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004486 return RHSTy;
4487 }
4488 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4489 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4490 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004491 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004492 return LHSTy;
4493 }
4494 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4495 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004496 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004497 return RHSTy;
4498 }
4499 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4500 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004501
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004502 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4503 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4504 return LHSTy;
4505 }
4506 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4507 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4508 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004509
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004510 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4511 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4512 // type. This allows
4513 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4514 // where B is a subclass of A.
4515 //
4516 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4517 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4518 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4519 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004520
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004521 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4522 // It could return the composite type.
4523 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4524 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4525 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4526 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4527 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4528 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4529 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4530 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4531 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4532 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4533 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4534 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4535 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4536 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004537 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004538 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4539 ;
4540 else {
4541 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4542 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4543 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4544 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004545 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4546 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004547 return incompatTy;
4548 }
4549 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004550 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
4551 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004552 return compositeType;
4553 }
4554 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
4555 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
4556 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4557 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4558 QualType destPointee
4559 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
4560 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4561 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004562 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004563 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004564 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004565 return destType;
4566 }
4567 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4568 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4569 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4570 QualType destPointee
4571 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
4572 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
4573 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004574 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004575 // Promote to void*.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004576 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahaniana430f712009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004577 return destType;
4578 }
4579 return QualType();
4580}
4581
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004582/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004583/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004584ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004585 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004586 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
4587 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattner2ab40a62007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004588 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
4589 // was the condition.
4590 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianc6bf0bd2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004591 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
4592 if (isLHSNull) {
4593 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
4594 }
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004595
Fariborz Jahanian2b1d88a2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004596 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
4597 SAVEExpr, QuestionLoc);
Steve Narofff8a28c52007-05-15 20:29:32 +00004598 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004599 return ExprError();
4600
Douglas Gregor7e112b02009-08-26 14:37:04 +00004601 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianc6bf0bd2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00004602 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
4603 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
4604 result));
Chris Lattnere168f762006-11-10 05:29:30 +00004605}
4606
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004607// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004608// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004609// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
4610// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
4611// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004612Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004613Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004614 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004615
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004616 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4617 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4618 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4619 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4620 return Compatible;
4621 }
4622
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004623 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004624 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4625 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004626
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004627 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004628 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4629 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004630
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004631 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004632
4633 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
4634 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
4635 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianece85822009-02-17 18:27:45 +00004636 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00004637 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004638 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004639
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004640 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
4641 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004642 // version of void...
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004643 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004644 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004645 return ConvTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004646
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004647 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004648 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
4649 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004650 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004651
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004652 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004653 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004654 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004655
4656 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerb3a176d2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00004657 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
4658 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattner0a788432008-01-03 22:56:36 +00004659 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004660 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Steve Naroff3f597292007-05-11 22:18:03 +00004661 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004662 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4663 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
4664 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
4665 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
4666 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
4667 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004668 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004669 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004670 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004671 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004672
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004673 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004674 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00004675 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004676 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattnerec3a1562009-10-17 20:33:28 +00004677
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004678 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
4679 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
4680 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
4681 // warning can be disabled.
4682 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
4683 return ConvTy;
4684 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
4685 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004686
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004687 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
4688 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
4689 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
4690 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
4691 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
4692 do {
4693 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4694 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004695
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004696 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4697 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4698 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004699
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004700 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00004701 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00004702 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004703
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004704 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004705 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00004706 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004707 return ConvTy;
Steve Naroff1f4d7272007-05-11 04:00:31 +00004708}
4709
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004710/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
4711/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
4712/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
4713// types.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004714Sema::AssignConvertType
4715Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004716 QualType rhsType) {
4717 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004718
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004719 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004720 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4721 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004722
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004723 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4724 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4725 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004726
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004727 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004728
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004729 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregor1b8fe5b72009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004730 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004731 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004732
Fariborz Jahanianb8b0ea32010-03-17 00:20:01 +00004733 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
4734 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4735 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
4736 }
4737 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004738 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004739 return ConvTy;
4740}
4741
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004742/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
4743/// for assignment compatibility.
4744Sema::AssignConvertType
4745Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004746 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4747 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004748 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4749 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004750 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004751 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004752 }
4753 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
4754 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian9b37b1d2010-03-24 21:00:27 +00004755 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
4756 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand5bb8cb2010-03-19 18:06:10 +00004757 return IncompatiblePointer;
4758 return Compatible;
4759 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004760 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004761 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004762 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004763 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4764 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
4765 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
4766 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
4767 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
4768 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004769
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004770 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
4771 return Compatible;
4772 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
4773 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004774 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004775}
4776
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004777/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
4778/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004779/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
4780///
4781/// int a, *pint;
4782/// short *pshort;
4783/// struct foo *pfoo;
4784///
4785/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4786/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
4787/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
4788/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
4789///
4790/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004791/// C99 spec dictates.
Steve Naroff17f76e02007-05-03 21:03:48 +00004792///
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00004793Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004794Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004795 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
4796 // them.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00004797 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
4798 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004799
4800 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerf5c973d2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00004801 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff44fd8ff2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00004802
David Chisnall9f57c292009-08-17 16:35:33 +00004803 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4804 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
4805 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
4806 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
4807 return Compatible;
4808 }
4809
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004810 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
4811 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
4812 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
4813 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
4814 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
4815 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
4816 // type.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004817 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00004818 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson24ebce62007-10-12 23:56:29 +00004819 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004820 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahaniana1e34202007-12-19 17:45:58 +00004821 }
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004822 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
4823 // to the same ExtVector type.
4824 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
4825 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
4826 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00004827 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004828 return Compatible;
4829 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004830
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00004831 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004832 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
4833 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
4834 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
4835 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
4836 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
4837 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00004838 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00004839
4840 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
4841 // vector type and vice versa
4842 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
4843 return Compatible;
Chris Lattner881a2122008-01-04 23:32:24 +00004844 }
4845 return Incompatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004846 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004847
Douglas Gregorbea453a2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00004848 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
4849 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004850 return Compatible;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004851
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004852 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004853 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004854 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004855
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004856 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004857 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004858
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004859 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004860 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004861 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4862 return Compatible;
4863 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004864 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004865 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
4866 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004867 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004868
4869 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004870 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004871 return Compatible;
4872 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004873 return Incompatible;
4874 }
4875
4876 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4877 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedman8163b7a2009-02-25 04:20:42 +00004878 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004879
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004880 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004881 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroff32d072c2008-09-29 18:10:17 +00004882 return Compatible;
4883
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004884 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4885 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004886
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004887 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004888 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004889 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00004890 }
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004891 return Incompatible;
4892 }
4893
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004894 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
4895 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
4896 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004897
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004898 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004899 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004900 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4901 return Compatible;
4902 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004903 }
4904 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian410f2eb2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00004905 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004906 }
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004907 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004908 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
4909 return Compatible;
4910 }
4911 // Treat block pointers as objects.
4912 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
4913 return Compatible;
4914 return Incompatible;
4915 }
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004916 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004917 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004918 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4919 return Compatible;
4920
4921 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00004922 return PointerToInt;
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004923
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004924 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004925 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004926
4927 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004928 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregore7dd1452008-11-27 00:44:28 +00004929 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004930 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004931 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004932 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
4933 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
4934 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
4935 return Compatible;
4936
4937 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
4938 return PointerToInt;
4939
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004940 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004941 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroffaccc4882009-07-20 17:56:53 +00004942 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
4943 return Compatible;
4944 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004945 }
4946 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004947 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00004948 return Compatible;
4949 return Incompatible;
4950 }
Eli Friedman3360d892008-05-30 18:07:22 +00004951
Chris Lattnera52c2f22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00004952 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattnerec646832008-04-07 06:49:41 +00004953 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004954 return Compatible;
Bill Wendling216423b2007-05-30 06:30:29 +00004955 }
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00004956 return Incompatible;
Steve Naroff9eb24652007-05-02 21:58:15 +00004957}
4958
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004959/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
4960/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004961static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004962 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
4963 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
4964 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenekac034612010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004965 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenek013041e2010-02-19 01:50:18 +00004966 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004967 SourceLocation());
4968 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
4969 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
4970
4971 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
4972 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004973 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall5d7aa7f2010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004974 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCalle15bbff2010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004975 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004976}
4977
4978Sema::AssignConvertType
4979Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
4980 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
4981
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004982 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004983 // transparent_union GCC extension.
4984 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidisb4b64ca2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00004985 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004986 return Incompatible;
4987
4988 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
4989 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
4990 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
4991 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidiscfbfe782009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004992 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
4993 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00004994 it != itend; ++it) {
4995 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
4996 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
4997 // 1) void pointer
4998 // 2) null pointer constant
4999 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005000 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005001 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005002 InitField = *it;
5003 break;
5004 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005005
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005006 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005007 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005008 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005009 InitField = *it;
5010 break;
5011 }
5012 }
5013
5014 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
5015 == Compatible) {
Daniel Dunbar60785eb2010-09-17 23:21:43 +00005016 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005017 InitField = *it;
5018 break;
5019 }
5020 }
5021
5022 if (!InitField)
5023 return Incompatible;
5024
5025 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
5026 return Compatible;
5027}
5028
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005029Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005030Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005031 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5032 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
5033 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5034 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5035 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor47d3f272008-12-19 17:40:08 +00005036 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005037 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005038 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner0d5640c2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00005039 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor9a657932008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005040 }
5041
5042 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5043 // structures.
5044 }
5045
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005046 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5047 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005048 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
5049 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005050 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005051 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005052 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005053 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0ee0b0a2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005054 return Compatible;
5055 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005056
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005057 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005058 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregora121b752009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005059 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyef7c0ff2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005060 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005061 //
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005062 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattnere6dcd502007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005063 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005064 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005065
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005066 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
5067 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005068
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005069 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5070 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor6b754842008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005071 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5072 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5073 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5074 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0cfbdab2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005075 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregora8a089b2010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005076 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005077 CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff0c1c7ed2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005078 return result;
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005079}
5080
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005081QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005082 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005083 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005084 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005085 return QualType();
Steve Naroff6f49f5d2007-05-29 14:23:36 +00005086}
5087
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005088QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005089 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005090 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattner574dee62008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005091 QualType lhsType =
5092 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5093 QualType rhsType =
5094 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005095
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005096 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman002e4bd2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005097 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005098 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005099
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005100 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5101 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005102 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005103 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005104 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005105 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005106 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005107 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005108 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005109 return lhsType;
5110 }
5111
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005112 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorcbfbca12010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005113 return rhsType;
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005114 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5115 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5116 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5117 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5118 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5119 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005120 }
Eric Christophera613f562010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005121 }
Chandler Carruth9ed87ba2010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005122 }
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005123 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005124
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005125 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5126 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5127 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005128 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor59e8b3b2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005129 return rhsType;
5130 }
5131
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005132 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5133 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5134 bool swapped = false;
5135 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5136 swapped = true;
5137 std::swap(rex, lex);
5138 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5139 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005140
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005141 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005142 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005143 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor6972a622010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005144 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005145 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005146 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005147 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5148 return lhsType;
5149 }
5150 }
5151 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5152 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5153 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005154 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begemanbd956c42009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005155 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5156 return lhsType;
5157 }
Nate Begeman330aaa72007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005158 }
5159 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005160
Nate Begeman886448d2009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005161 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005162 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005163 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005164 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff84ff4b42007-07-09 21:31:10 +00005165 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005166}
5167
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005168QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5169 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar060d5e22009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005170 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005171 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005172
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005173 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005174
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005175 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5176 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5177 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005178
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005179 // Check for division by zero.
5180 if (isDiv &&
5181 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005182 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005183 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005184
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005185 return compType;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005186}
5187
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005188QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005189 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005190 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005191 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5192 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar0d2bfec2009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005193 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5194 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5195 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005196
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005197 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005198
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005199 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5200 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005201
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005202 // Check for remainder by zero.
5203 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattner70117952010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005204 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5205 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005206
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005207 return compType;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005208}
5209
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005210QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005211 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005212 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5213 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5214 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5215 return compType;
5216 }
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005217
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005218 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005219
Steve Naroffe4718892007-04-27 18:30:00 +00005220 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005221 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5222 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5223 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005224 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005225 }
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005226
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005227 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5228 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005229 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005230 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5231
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005232 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005233
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005234 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005235 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005236
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005237 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5238 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005239 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5240 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattner3b054132008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005241 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005242 return QualType();
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005243 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005244
5245 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5246 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5247 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005248 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005249 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5250 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5251 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5252 return QualType();
5253 }
5254
5255 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5256 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5257 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005258 } else {
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005259 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005260 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroffa63372d2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005261 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005262 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5263 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005264 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5265 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005266 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroffaacd4cc2009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005267 return QualType();
5268 }
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005269 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005270 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005271 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5272 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5273 return QualType();
5274 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005275
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005276 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005277 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5278 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5279 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5280 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5281 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005282 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005283 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5284 }
Eli Friedman8e122982008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005285 return PExp->getType();
5286 }
5287 }
5288
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005289 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005290}
5291
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005292// C99 6.5.6
5293QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005294 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5295 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5296 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5297 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5298 return compType;
5299 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005300
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005301 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005302
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005303 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005304
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005305 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005306 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5307 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005308 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005309 return compType;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005310 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005311
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005312 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005313 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff4eed7a12009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005314 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005315
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005316 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005317
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005318 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5319 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5320 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5321 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5322 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5323 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5324 return QualType();
5325 }
5326
5327 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5328 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5329 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5330 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5331 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005332 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005333 return QualType();
5334 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005335
5336 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5337 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5338 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005339 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005340 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005341 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005342 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005343 return QualType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005344
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005345 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005346 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner12bdebb2009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005347 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5348 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5349 return QualType();
5350 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005351
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005352 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005353 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5354 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5355 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5356 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5357 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5358 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005359 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005360 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5361
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005362 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005363 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005364 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005365
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005366 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005367 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman1974e532008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005368 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005369
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005370 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5371 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5372 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5373 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5374 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5375 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5376 return QualType();
5377 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005378
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005379 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5380 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5381 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5382 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005383 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005384 return QualType();
5385 }
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005386
5387 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5388 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5389 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5390 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5391 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005392 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5393 << rex->getSourceRange()
5394 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005395 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005396
Eli Friedman168fe152009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005397 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5398 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5399 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5400 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5401 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5402 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5403 return QualType();
5404 }
5405 } else {
5406 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5407 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5408 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5409 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5410 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5411 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5412 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5413 return QualType();
5414 }
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005415 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005416
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005417 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5418 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5419 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5420 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5421 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005422 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregorac1fb652009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005423 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005424
5425 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner4d62f422007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005426 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5427 }
5428 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005429
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005430 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005431}
5432
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005433static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
5434 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T))
5435 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
5436 return false;
5437}
5438
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005439// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005440QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattner2a3569b2008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005441 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005442 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005443 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5444 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005445 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005446
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005447 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
5448 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
5449 if (isScopedEnumerationType(lex->getType()) ||
5450 isScopedEnumerationType(rex->getType())) {
5451 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5452 }
5453
Nate Begemane46ee9a2009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005454 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5455 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5456 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5457
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005458 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5459 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman629ffb92009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005460 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5461 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5462 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5463 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5464 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005465 }
Chris Lattner3c133402007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005466 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005467 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005468
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005469 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005470
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005471 // Sanity-check shift operands
5472 llvm::APSInt Right;
5473 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar687fa862009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005474 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5475 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn2f085712009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005476 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnf53fab82009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005477 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5478 else {
5479 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5480 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5481 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5482 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5483 }
5484 }
5485
Chris Lattner5c11c412007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005486 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005487 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005488}
5489
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005490static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5491 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5492 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5493 return true;
5494 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5495 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5496 }
5497 return false;
5498}
5499
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005500// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005501QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005502 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005503 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005504
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005505 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005506 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005507 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005508
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005509 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5510 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005511
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005512 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Ted Kremenek853734e2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005513 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational) &&
5514 !lex->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
5515 !rex->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005516 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5517 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5518 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth65a38182010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005519 //
5520 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5521 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5522 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5523 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5524 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5525 // result.
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005526 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5527 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005528 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005529 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenek853734e2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005530 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005531 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005532 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5533 << 0 // self-
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005534 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5535 || Opc == BO_LE
5536 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005537 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5538 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5539 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5540 // what is it always going to eval to?
5541 char always_evals_to;
5542 switch(Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005543 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005544 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5545 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005546 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005547 always_evals_to = 1; // true
5548 break;
5549 default:
5550 // best we can say is 'a constant'
5551 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
5552 break;
5553 }
5554 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5555 << 1 // array
5556 << always_evals_to);
5557 }
5558 }
Chandler Carruth17773fc2010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005559 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005560
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005561 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
5562 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
5563 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
5564 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005565
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005566 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
5567 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005568 Expr *literalString = 0;
5569 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner222b8bd2009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005570 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005571 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005572 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005573 literalString = lex;
5574 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stump12b8ce12009-08-04 21:02:39 +00005575 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
5576 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005577 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005578 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005579 literalString = rex;
5580 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
5581 }
5582
5583 if (literalString) {
5584 std::string resultComparison;
5585 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005586 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
5587 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
5588 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
5589 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
5590 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
5591 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005592 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
5593 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005594
Douglas Gregor49862b82010-01-12 23:18:54 +00005595 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5596 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
5597 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek800b66b2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00005598 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005599 }
Ted Kremeneke451eae2007-10-29 16:58:49 +00005600 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005601
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005602 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
5603 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5604 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
5605 else {
5606 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5607 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
5608 }
5609
5610 lType = lex->getType();
5611 rType = rex->getType();
5612
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005613 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner9a152e22009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005614 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005615
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005616 if (isRelational) {
5617 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005618 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005619 } else {
Ted Kremeneke2763b02007-10-29 17:13:39 +00005620 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005621 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005622 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005623
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005624 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005625 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnerb620c342007-08-26 01:18:55 +00005626 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005627
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005628 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005629 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005630 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005631 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005632
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005633 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
5634 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff808eb8f2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00005635 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005636 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005637 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattner3a0702e2008-04-03 05:07:25 +00005638 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005639 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005640
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005641 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005642 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
5643 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005644 if (!isRelational &&
5645 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5646 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5647 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005648 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
5649 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005650 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5651 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005652 Diag(Loc,
5653 isSFINAEContext()?
5654 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
5655 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005656 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005657
5658 if (isSFINAEContext())
5659 return QualType();
5660
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005661 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianffc420c2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00005662 return ResultTy;
5663 }
5664 }
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005665 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
5666 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
5667 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
5668 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
5669 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
5670 //
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005671 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005672 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005673 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005674 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005675 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005676 if (T.isNull()) {
5677 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5678 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5679 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005680 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005681 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005682 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005683 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005684 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005685 }
5686
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005687 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5688 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor5b07c7e2009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005689 return ResultTy;
5690 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005691 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
5692 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
5693 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
5694 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
5695 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
5696 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
5697 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5698 }
5699 } else if (!isRelational &&
5700 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
5701 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
5702 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
5703 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
5704 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
5705 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5706 }
5707 } else {
5708 // Invalid
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005709 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005710 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff75c17232007-06-13 21:41:08 +00005711 }
Eli Friedman16c209612009-08-23 00:27:47 +00005712 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005713 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005714 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffcdee44c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00005715 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005716
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005717 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005718 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005719 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005720 if (RHSIsNull &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005721 (lType->isPointerType() ||
5722 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005723 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
5724 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005725 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5726 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005727 return ResultTy;
5728 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005729 if (LHSIsNull &&
5730 (rType->isPointerType() ||
5731 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregorf58ff322010-08-07 13:36:37 +00005732 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
5733 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005734 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
5735 : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005736 return ResultTy;
5737 }
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005738
5739 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005740 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005741 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
5742 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005743 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
5744 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
5745 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
5746 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
5747 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
5748 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
5749 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
5750 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005751 // types.
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005752 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor19175ff2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00005753 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005754 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005755 if (T.isNull()) {
5756 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005757 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005758 return QualType();
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005759 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005760 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005761 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005762 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregor6f5f6422010-02-25 22:29:57 +00005763 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005764 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005765
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005766 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
5767 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005768 return ResultTy;
5769 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005770
Douglas Gregorb00b10e2009-08-24 17:42:35 +00005771 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
Sebastian Redl576fd422009-05-10 18:38:11 +00005772 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
5773 return ResultTy;
5774 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005775
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005776 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005777 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005778 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5779 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005780
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005781 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedmana6638ca2009-06-08 05:08:54 +00005782 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005783 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005784 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005785 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005786 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005787 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005788 }
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005789 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005790 if (!isRelational
5791 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
5792 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005793 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005794 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005795 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005796 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stump1b821b42009-05-07 03:14:14 +00005797 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
5798 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
5799 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005800 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005801 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005802 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe18f94c2008-09-28 01:11:11 +00005803 }
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005804
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005805 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005806 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenekc23c7e62009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005807 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
5808 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005809 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005810 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005811 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005812 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005813
Steve Naroff753567f2008-11-17 19:49:16 +00005814 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
5815 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattner377d1f82008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005816 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005817 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1d4a9a32008-10-27 10:33:19 +00005818 }
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005819 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005820 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffea54d9e2008-10-20 18:19:10 +00005821 }
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005822 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005823 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005824 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
5825 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005826 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005827 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffb788d9b2008-06-03 14:04:54 +00005828 }
Fariborz Jahanian134cbef2007-12-20 01:06:58 +00005829 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005830 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
5831 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005832 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005833 bool isError = false;
5834 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
5835 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
5836 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005837 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005838 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005839 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005840 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5841 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
5842 isError = true;
5843 } else
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005844 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005845
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005846 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005847 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattnerd466ea12009-06-30 06:24:05 +00005848 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005849 if (isError)
5850 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerf8344db2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00005851 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005852
5853 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005854 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattnerd99bd522009-08-23 00:03:44 +00005855 else
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005856 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005857 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00005858 }
Douglas Gregorf267edd2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00005859
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005860 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005861 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
5862 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005863 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005864 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005865 }
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005866 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
5867 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005868 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregorca63811b2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00005869 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff4b191572008-09-04 16:56:14 +00005870 }
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005871 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005872}
5873
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005874/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005875/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005876/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
5877/// types.
5878QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005879 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005880 bool isRelational) {
5881 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
5882 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005883 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005884 if (vType.isNull())
5885 return vType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005886
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005887 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5888 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005889
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005890 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5891 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5892 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005893 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005894 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
5895 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
5896 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregorec170db2010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005897 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
5898 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5899 << 0 // self-
5900 << 2 // "a constant"
5901 );
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005902 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005903
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005904 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor4ffbad12010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005905 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
5906 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005907 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005908 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005909
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005910 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
5911 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
5912 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005913 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005914 return lType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005915
John McCall9dd450b2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005916 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005917 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005918 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005919 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattner5d688962009-03-31 07:46:52 +00005920 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005921 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5922
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005923 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman2f2bdeb2009-01-18 03:20:47 +00005924 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begeman191a6b12008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005925 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
5926}
5927
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005928inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005929 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregor5cc2c8b2010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005930 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5931 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5932 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
5933 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5934
5935 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5936 }
Steve Naroffb8ea4fb2007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005937
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005938 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005939
Douglas Gregor0bf31402010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005940 if (lex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
5941 rex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
Steve Naroffbe4c4d12007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005942 return compType;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005943 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00005944}
5945
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00005946inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005947 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
5948
5949 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
5950 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
5951 // is a constant.
5952 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman6b197e02010-07-27 19:14:53 +00005953 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattnerdeee7a32010-07-15 00:26:43 +00005954 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005955 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
5956 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
5957 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
5958 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
5959 Expr::EvalResult Result;
5960 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
5961 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
5962 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
5963 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005964 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
5965 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattner938533d2010-07-24 01:10:11 +00005966 }
5967 }
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00005968
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005969 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5970 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
5971 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005972
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005973 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
5974 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005975
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005976 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson35a99d92009-10-16 01:44:21 +00005977 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005978
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005979 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
5980 // non-overloadable operands.
5981
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005982 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
5983 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall4a2429a2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00005984 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
5985 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
5986 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005987 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005988
Anders Carlsson2e7bc112009-11-23 21:47:44 +00005989 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
5990 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
5991 // The result is a bool.
5992 return Context.BoolTy;
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00005993}
5994
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00005995/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
5996/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
5997/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
5998///
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005999static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006000 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
6001 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
6002 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
6003 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006004 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006005 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
6006 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
6007 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
6008 return true;
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006009 }
6010 }
6011 return false;
6012}
6013
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006014/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
6015/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
6016static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006017 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006018 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006019 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahanian8e1555c2009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006020 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
6021 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006022 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
6023 return false;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006024
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006025 unsigned Diag = 0;
6026 bool NeedType = false;
6027 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006028 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006029 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006030 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6031 NeedType = true;
6032 break;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006033 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006034 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6035 NeedType = true;
6036 break;
Chris Lattner9b3bbe92008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006037 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006038 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6039 break;
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006040 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6041 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006042 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006043 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6044 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006045 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6046 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006047 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6048 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregored0cfbd2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006049 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006050 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssond624e162009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006051 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006052 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006053 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6054 break;
Steve Naroffba756cb2008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006055 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006056 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6057 break;
Fariborz Jahanian8a1810f2008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006058 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6059 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6060 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5118c412008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006061 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6062 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6063 break;
Fariborz Jahaniane8d28902009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006064 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6065 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6066 break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006067 }
Steve Naroffad373bd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006068
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006069 SourceRange Assign;
6070 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6071 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006072 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbarc2223ab2009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006073 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006074 else
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006075 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006076 return true;
6077}
6078
6079
6080
6081// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006082QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6083 SourceLocation Loc,
6084 QualType CompoundType) {
6085 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6086 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattner30bd3272008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006087 return QualType();
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006088
6089 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6090 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006091 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006092 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006093 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006094 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006095 ConvertPropertyAssignment(LHS, RHS, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanianbe21aa32010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006096 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006097 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6098 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6099 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006100 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006101 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Naroff79d12152009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006102 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanian255c0952009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006103 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006104
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006105 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6106 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6107 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006108 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006109 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6110 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6111 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006112 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6113 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006114 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006115 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006116 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6117 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6118 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattnered9f14c2009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006119 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6120 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006121 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006122 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006123 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner36c39c92009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006124 }
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006125 }
6126 } else {
6127 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedmanb05c41e2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006128 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattnerea714382008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006129 }
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006130
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006131 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor7c3bbdf2009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006132 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006133 return QualType();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006134
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006135
6136 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6137 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6138 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6139 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6140 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6141 // check.
6142 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006143 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner39561062010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006144 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6145 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6146 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6147 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6148 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6149 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6150 }
6151
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006152 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6153 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006154 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Steve Naroff98cf3e92007-06-06 18:38:38 +00006155 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6156 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006157 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregord2c2d172009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006158 // operand.
John McCall01cbf2d2010-10-12 02:19:57 +00006159 return (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6160 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType());
Steve Naroffae4143e2007-04-26 20:39:23 +00006161}
6162
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006163// C99 6.5.17
6164QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis639ffb02010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006165 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6166
John McCall73d36182010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006167 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
6168 // operands, but not unary promotions.
6169 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6170 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6171 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS);
6172 if (!LHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6173 RequireCompleteType(Loc, LHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006174
John McCall73d36182010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006175 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
6176 if (!RHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6177 RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
6178 }
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006179
Chris Lattner326f7572008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006180 return RHS->getType();
Steve Naroff95af0132007-03-30 23:47:58 +00006181}
6182
Steve Naroff7a5af782007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006183/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6184/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006185QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006186 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006187 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6188 return Context.DependentTy;
6189
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006190 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6191 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Steve Naroffd50c88e2007-04-05 21:15:20 +00006192
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006193 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6194 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6195 if (!isInc) {
6196 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6197 return QualType();
6198 }
6199 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6200 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6201 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006202 // OK!
Steve Naroff6b712a72009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006203 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6204 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006205
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006206 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006207 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006208 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6209 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6210 << Op->getSourceRange();
6211 return QualType();
6212 }
6213
6214 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006215 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006216 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6cd9282009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006217 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6218 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6219 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6220 return QualType();
6221 }
6222
6223 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006224 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7cae42b2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006225 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006226 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006227 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlsson029fc692009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006228 << ResType))
Douglas Gregordd430f72009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006229 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006230 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCall8b07ec22010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006231 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanianca75db72009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006232 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6233 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6234 return QualType();
6235 }
Eli Friedman090addd2010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006236 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006237 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6238 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006239 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006240 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6241 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6242 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6243 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc, isInc, isPrefix);
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006244 } else {
6245 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor906db8a2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006246 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006247 return QualType();
Steve Naroff46ba1eb2007-04-03 23:13:13 +00006248 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006249 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroff9e1e5512007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006250 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner6b0cf142008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006251 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006252 return QualType();
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006253 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6254 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6255 // operand.
6256 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6257 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Steve Naroff26c8ea52007-03-21 21:08:52 +00006258}
6259
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006260void Sema::ConvertPropertyAssignment(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, QualType& LHSTy) {
6261 bool copyInit = false;
6262 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6263 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6264 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6265 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6266 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6267 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6268 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6269 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6270 }
6271 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType());
6272 }
6273 else
6274 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(LHS) &&
6275 LHSTy->isRecordType());
6276 if (copyInit) {
6277 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006278 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006279 Expr *Arg = RHS;
6280 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(),
6281 Owned(Arg));
6282 if (!ArgE.isInvalid())
Fariborz Jahanian8fb87ae2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006283 RHS = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006284 }
6285}
6286
6287
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006288/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006289/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006290/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6291/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6292/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6293/// - &(x) => x
6294/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6295/// - &s.xx => s
6296/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6297/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6298/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6299/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006300static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006301 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006302 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006303 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006304 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006305 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6306 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6307 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006308 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006309 return 0;
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006310 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006311 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006312 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump87c57ac2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006313 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6314 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006315 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6316 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6317 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6318 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6319 }
6320 return 0;
Anders Carlsson806700f2008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006321 }
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006322 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6323 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006324
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006325 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006326 case UO_Real:
6327 case UO_Imag:
6328 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbarb692ef42008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006329 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6330 default:
6331 return 0;
6332 }
6333 }
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006334 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006335 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006336 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006337 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6338 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattner24d5bfe2008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006339 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006340 default:
6341 return 0;
6342 }
6343}
6344
6345/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006346/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006347/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006348/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Steve Naroffa78fe7e2007-05-16 19:47:19 +00006349/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006350/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006351/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006352QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6353 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006354 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006355 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6356 return Context.OverloadTy;
6357
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006358 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp, OpLoc);
6359 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6360 OrigOp = PR.take();
6361
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006362 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6363 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor19b8c4f2008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006364
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006365 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6366 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6367 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006368 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff826e91a2008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006369 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6370 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6371 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6372 }
6373 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6374 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6375 }
Douglas Gregor5251f1b2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006376 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner67315442008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006377 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes17f345f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006378
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006379 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregorb154fdc2010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006380 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6381 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6382 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6383 if (isSFINAEContext())
6384 return QualType();
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006385 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006386 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall8d08b9b2010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006387 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6388 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6389 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6390
6391 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6392 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6393 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6394 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6395 return QualType();
6396 }
6397 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6398 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6399
6400 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6401 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6402 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6403 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6404
6405 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6406 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6407 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6408 << op->getSourceRange();
6409 }
6410
6411 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6412 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6413 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006414 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006415 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006416 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner48d52842007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006417 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006418 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6419 << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006420 return QualType();
6421 }
Douglas Gregor71235ec2009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006422 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006423 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6424 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6425 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor2eedc3a2008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006426 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson8abde4b2010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006427 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman3a1e6922009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006428 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006429 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemana6b47a42009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006430 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006431 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian385db802009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006432 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6433 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6434 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6435 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6436 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson3fa58d12009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006437 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6438 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson01ccf992009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006439 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6440 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffb96e4ab62008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006441 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006442 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006443 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6444 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006445 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6446 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCall8e7d6562010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006447 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahaniane0fd5a92010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006448 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006449 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6450 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006451 return QualType();
6452 }
John McCalld14a8642009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006453 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregorcd695e52008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006454 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006455 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor9aa8b552008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006456 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006457 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6458 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregor4bd90e52009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006459 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006460 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006461 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6462 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006463 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006464 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6465 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6466 return QualType();
6467 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006468
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006469 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6470 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlsson0b675f52009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006471 }
Sebastian Redl3d3f75a2009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006472 }
Anders Carlsson5b535762009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006473 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Steve Narofff633d092007-04-25 19:01:39 +00006474 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006475 }
Sebastian Redl18f8ff62009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006476
Eli Friedmance7f9002009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006477 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6478 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6479 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6480 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6481 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6482 }
6483
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006484 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor0bdcb8a2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006485 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6486 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006487 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
Steve Naroff47500512007-04-19 23:00:49 +00006488}
6489
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006490/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006491QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006492 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6493 return Context.DependentTy;
6494
Chris Lattner6a2ed6f2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006495 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006496 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6497 QualType Result;
6498
6499 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6500 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6501 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6502 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6503 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6504 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6505 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6506 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6507 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006508 else {
6509 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6510 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6511 if (PR.take() != Op) return CheckIndirectionOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc);
6512 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006513
Chris Lattner9156f1b2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006514 if (Result.isNull()) {
6515 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6516 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6517 return QualType();
6518 }
6519
6520 return Result;
Steve Naroff1926c832007-04-24 00:23:05 +00006521}
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006522
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006523static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006524 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006525 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006526 switch (Kind) {
6527 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006528 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6529 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6530 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6531 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6532 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
6533 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
6534 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
6535 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
6536 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
6537 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
6538 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
6539 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
6540 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
6541 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
6542 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
6543 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
6544 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
6545 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
6546 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
6547 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
6548 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
6549 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
6550 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
6551 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
6552 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
6553 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
6554 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
6555 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
6556 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
6557 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
6558 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
6559 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006560 }
6561 return Opc;
6562}
6563
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006564static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006565 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006566 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006567 switch (Kind) {
6568 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006569 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
6570 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
6571 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
6572 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
6573 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
6574 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
6575 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
6576 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
6577 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
6578 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
6579 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006580 }
6581 return Opc;
6582}
6583
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006584/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
6585/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
6586/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006587ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006588 unsigned Op,
6589 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006590 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006591 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006592 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
6593 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
6594 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006595
6596 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006597 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006598 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
6599 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006600 case BO_PtrMemD:
6601 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006602 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006603 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl112a97662009-02-07 00:15:38 +00006604 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006605 case BO_Mul:
6606 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006607 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006608 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006609 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006610 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006611 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6612 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006613 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006614 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6615 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006616 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006617 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6618 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006619 case BO_Shl:
6620 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006621 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6622 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006623 case BO_LE:
6624 case BO_LT:
6625 case BO_GE:
6626 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006627 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006628 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006629 case BO_EQ:
6630 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregor7a5bc762009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006631 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006632 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006633 case BO_And:
6634 case BO_Xor:
6635 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006636 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6637 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006638 case BO_LAnd:
6639 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner8406c512010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006640 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006641 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006642 case BO_MulAssign:
6643 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattnerfaa54172010-01-12 21:23:57 +00006644 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006645 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006646 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6647 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6648 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006649 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006650 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006651 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6652 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6653 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6654 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006655 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006656 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006657 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6658 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6659 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006660 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006661 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006662 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
6663 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6664 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006665 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006666 case BO_ShlAssign:
6667 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006668 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6669 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6670 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6671 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006672 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006673 case BO_AndAssign:
6674 case BO_XorAssign:
6675 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006676 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
6677 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
6678 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
6679 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006680 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006681 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006682 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
6683 break;
6684 }
6685 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006686 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006687 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006688 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian99311ba2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00006689 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
6690 << ResultTy;
6691 }
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006692 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006693 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
6694 else
6695 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedman8b7b1b12009-03-28 01:22:36 +00006696 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
6697 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006698}
6699
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006700/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
6701/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006702static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
6703 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006704 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
6705 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
6706 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006707 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006708 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
6709
6710 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
6711 return;
6712
6713 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
6714 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6715 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006716 return;
6717 }
6718
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006719 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
6720 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006721 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006722
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006723 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006724 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006725
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006726 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
6727 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
6728 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
6729 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006730 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006731 return;
6732 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006733
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006734 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00006735 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
6736 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006737}
6738
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006739/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
6740/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
6741/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
6742/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006743static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006744 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006745 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
6746 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
6747 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
6748 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006749 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006750 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006751 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
6752
6753 // Subs are not binary operators.
6754 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
6755 return;
6756
6757 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
6758 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006759 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
6760 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006761 return;
6762
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006763 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006764 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006765 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006766 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
6767 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006768 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006769 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006770 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
6771 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6772 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
6773 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006774 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl4afb7c582009-10-26 17:01:32 +00006775 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006776 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006777 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
6778 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregor89336232010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006779 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00006780 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00006781 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
6782 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
6783 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
6784 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006785}
6786
6787/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
6788/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
6789/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006790static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006791 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redl44615072009-10-27 12:10:02 +00006792 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006793 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
6794}
6795
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006796// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006797ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006798 tok::TokenKind Kind,
6799 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
6800 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Naroff83895f72007-09-16 03:34:24 +00006801 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
6802 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006803
Sebastian Redl43028242009-10-26 15:24:15 +00006804 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
6805 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
6806
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006807 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
6808}
6809
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006810ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006811 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
6812 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006813 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Fariborz Jahanian805b74e2010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006814 ((!isa<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(lhs) &&
6815 !isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(lhs))
Fariborz Jahanianaaf44b22010-09-17 20:45:45 +00006816 || rhs->isTypeDependent() || Opc != BO_Assign) &&
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006817 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006818 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
6819 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6820 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6821 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6822 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006823 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006824 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006825 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6826 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
6827 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006828
Douglas Gregor1baf54e2009-03-13 18:40:31 +00006829 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
6830 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006831 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb5d49352009-01-19 22:31:54 +00006832 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006833
Douglas Gregor7d5fc7e2008-11-06 23:29:22 +00006834 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006835 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Steve Naroff218bc2b2007-05-04 21:54:46 +00006836}
6837
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006838ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006839 unsigned OpcIn,
6840 Expr *Input) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006841 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006842
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006843 QualType resultType;
6844 switch (Opc) {
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006845 case UO_PreInc:
6846 case UO_PreDec:
6847 case UO_PostInc:
6848 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle10c2c32008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006849 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006850 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6851 Opc == UO_PostInc,
6852 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
6853 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006854 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006855 case UO_AddrOf:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006856 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006857 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006858 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006859 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006860 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006861 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006862 case UO_Plus:
6863 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006864 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6865 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006866 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6867 break;
Douglas Gregora3208f92010-06-22 23:41:02 +00006868 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6869 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006870 break;
6871 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
6872 resultType->isEnumeralType())
6873 break;
6874 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006875 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006876 resultType->isPointerType())
6877 break;
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006878 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6879 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6880 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6881 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6882 }
Douglas Gregord08452f2008-11-19 15:42:04 +00006883
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006884 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6885 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006886 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006887 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
6888 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006889 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6890 break;
Chris Lattner0d707612008-07-25 23:52:49 +00006891 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
6892 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
6893 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattner29e812b2008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006894 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattner1e5665e2008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006895 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006896 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
6897 break;
6898 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6899 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6900 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6901 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6902 } else {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006903 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6904 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006905 }
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006906 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006907 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Steve Naroff71b59a92007-06-04 22:22:31 +00006908 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00006909 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroff31090012007-07-16 21:54:35 +00006910 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006911 if (resultType->isDependentType())
6912 break;
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006913 if (resultType->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.3.3p1
6914 // ok, fallthrough
6915 } else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6916 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
6917 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
6918 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
6919 } else {
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006920 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
6921 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006922 }
Douglas Gregordb8c6fd2010-09-20 17:13:33 +00006923
Chris Lattnerbe31ed82007-06-02 19:11:33 +00006924 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006925 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
6926 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006927 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006928 case UO_Real:
6929 case UO_Imag:
6930 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattner30b5dd02007-08-24 21:16:53 +00006931 break;
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006932 case UO_Extension:
Chris Lattner86554282007-06-08 22:32:33 +00006933 resultType = Input->getType();
Steve Naroff043d45d2007-05-15 02:32:35 +00006934 break;
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006935 }
6936 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redlc215cfc2009-01-19 00:08:26 +00006937 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006938
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006939 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Steve Naroff35d85152007-05-07 00:24:15 +00006940}
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006941
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006942ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006943 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
6944 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlsson461a2c02009-11-14 21:26:41 +00006945 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman8ed2bac2010-09-05 23:15:52 +00006946 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006947 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
6948 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
6949 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
6950 // the arguments.
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006951 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006952 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall4c4c1df2010-01-26 03:27:55 +00006953 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
6954 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
6955 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006956
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006957 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006958 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006959
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006960 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregor084d8552009-03-13 23:49:33 +00006961}
6962
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006963// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006964ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006965 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
6966 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor5287f092009-11-05 00:51:44 +00006967}
6968
Steve Naroff66356bd2007-09-16 14:56:35 +00006969/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006970ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006971 SourceLocation LabLoc,
6972 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006973 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00006974 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006975
Daniel Dunbar88402ce2008-08-04 16:51:22 +00006976 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
6977 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroff846b1ec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00006978 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Narofff6009ed2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00006979 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006980
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00006981 LabelDecl->setUsed();
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006982 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006983 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
6984 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Chris Lattnereefa10e2007-05-28 06:56:27 +00006985}
6986
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00006987ExprResult
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00006988Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006989 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006990 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
6991 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
6992
Douglas Gregor6cf3f3c2010-03-10 04:54:39 +00006993 bool isFileScope
6994 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattnera69b0762009-04-25 19:11:05 +00006995 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00006996 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedman52cc0162009-01-24 23:09:00 +00006997
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00006998 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
6999 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
7000 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007001
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007002 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
7003 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
7004 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007005
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007006 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
7007 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
7008 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
7009 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt))
7010 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007011
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007012 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt))
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007013 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Chris Lattner944d3062008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007014 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007015
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007016 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
7017 // expressions are not lvalues.
7018
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007019 return Owned(new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc));
Chris Lattner366727f2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007020}
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007021
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007022ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007023 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7024 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7025 unsigned NumComponents,
7026 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007027 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007028 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnara1108e7b2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00007029 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007030
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007031 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
7032 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
7033 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007034 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007035 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7036 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
7037
7038 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
7039 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
7040 if (!Dependent
7041 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
7042 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
7043 << TypeRange))
7044 return ExprError();
7045
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007046 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
7047 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman988a16b2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00007048 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
7049 // a system header!
Chris Lattner78502cf2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007050 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerf490e152008-11-19 05:27:50 +00007051 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
7052 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007053
7054 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
7055 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
7056 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
7057 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
7058 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
7059 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
7060 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
7061 if (OC.isBrackets) {
7062 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
7063 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7064 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
7065 if(!AT)
7066 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
7067 << CurrentType);
7068 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
7069 } else
7070 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7071
7072 // The expression must be an integral expression.
7073 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
7074 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
7075 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
7076 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
7077 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
7078 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
7079 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7080
7081 // Record this array index.
7082 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
7083 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
7084 continue;
7085 }
7086
7087 // Offset of a field.
7088 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7089 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
7090 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
7091 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
7092 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7093 continue;
7094 }
7095
7096 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
7097 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
7098 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7099 return ExprError();
7100
7101 // Look for the designated field.
7102 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
7103 if (!RC)
7104 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7105 << CurrentType);
7106 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
7107
7108 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
7109 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
7110 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
7111 // (clause 9).
7112 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
7113 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7114 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7115 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
7116 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7117 << CurrentType))
7118 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
7119 }
7120
7121 // Look for the field.
7122 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7123 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
7124 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
7125 if (!MemberDecl)
7126 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
7127 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
7128 OC.LocEnd));
7129
Douglas Gregor10982ea2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007130 // C99 7.17p3:
7131 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7132 //
7133 // We diagnose this as an error.
7134 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7135 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7136 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7137 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
7138 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7139 return ExprError();
7140 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007141
7142 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7143 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7144 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7145 do {
7146 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7147 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7148 }
7149
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007150 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7151 // the base class indirections.
7152 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7153 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007154 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregord1702062010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007155 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7156 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7157 B != BEnd; ++B)
7158 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7159 }
Eli Friedman74ef7cf2010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007160
7161 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007162 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7163 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7164 unsigned n = Path.size();
7165 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7166 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7167 } else {
7168 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7169 }
7170 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7171 }
7172
7173 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7174 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7175 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7176}
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007177
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007178ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007179 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7180 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
7181 ParsedType argty,
7182 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7183 unsigned NumComponents,
7184 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7185
Douglas Gregor882211c2010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007186 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7187 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7188 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7189 return ExprError();
7190
Eli Friedman06dcfd92010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007191 if (!ArgTInfo)
7192 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7193
7194 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7195 RPLoc);
Chris Lattnerf17bd422007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007196}
7197
7198
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007199ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007200 ParsedType arg1, ParsedType arg2,
7201 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007202 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7203 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7204 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7205 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007206
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007207 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007208
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007209 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7210}
7211
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007212ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007213Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7214 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7215 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7216 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorf907cbf2009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007217 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7218 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7219 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7220 return ExprError();
7221 }
7222
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007223 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007224 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroff78864672007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007225}
7226
Abramo Bagnara092990a2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007227
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007228ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007229 Expr *CondExpr,
7230 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
7231 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007232 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7233
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007234 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007235 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregor0df91122009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007236 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007237 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007238 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007239 } else {
7240 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7241 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7242 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7243 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007244 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7245 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7246 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007247
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007248 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7249 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007250 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7251 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl8d2ccae2009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007252 }
7253
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007254 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregor56751b52009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007255 resType, RPLoc,
7256 resType->isDependentType(),
7257 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroff9efdabc2007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007258}
7259
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007260//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7261// Clang Extensions.
7262//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7263
7264/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007265void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007266 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7267 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7268 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007269 if (BlockScope)
7270 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7271 else
7272 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007273}
7274
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007275void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpf70bcf72009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007276 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007277 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007278
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007279 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007280 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCall8cb7bdf2010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007281 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007282
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007283 bool isVariadic;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007284 QualType RetTy;
7285 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007286 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007287 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007288 isVariadic =
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007289 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7290 } else {
7291 RetTy = T;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007292 isVariadic = false;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007293 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007294
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007295 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007296
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007297 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7298 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7299 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump82f071f2009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007300 return;
7301 }
7302
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007303 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7304 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7305 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7306 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7307 return;
7308 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007309
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007310 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007311 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7312 // ^ * { ... }
7313 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007314 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7315 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007316
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007317 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007318 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007319 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7320 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7321 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7322 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007323 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7324 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7325 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7326 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7327 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007328 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian5ec502e2010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007329 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007330
7331 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7332 // ^ fntype { ... }
7333 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7334 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7335 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7336 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7337 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7338 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7339 *I);
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007340 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007341 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007342 }
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007343
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007344 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
7345 if (!Params.empty())
7346 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007347
7348 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor758a8692009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007349 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007350
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007351 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007352 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7353 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7354 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7355 }
7356
7357 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7358 // if we don't have any.
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007359 if (Params.empty())
John McCalla3ccba02010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007360 return;
7361
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007362 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7363 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7364
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007365 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007366 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7367 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7368
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007369 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007370 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7371 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7372 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7373
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007374 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCalldf8b37c2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007375 }
John McCallf7b2fb52010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007376 }
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007377}
7378
7379/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7380/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7381void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007382 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner41b86942009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007383 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007384 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007385 // FIXME: Delete the ParmVarDecl objects as well???
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007386}
7387
7388/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7389/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007390ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007391 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9eac9312009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007392 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7393 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7394 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007395
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007396 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahanian1babe772010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007397
Steve Naroff1d95e5a2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007398 PopDeclContext();
7399
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007400 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian3fd73102009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007401 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7402 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007403
Mike Stump3bf1ab42009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007404 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007405 QualType BlockTy;
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007406
7407 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7408 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7409 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7410
7411 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7412 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7413
7414 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7415 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7416 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7417 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7418
7419 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7420 // preserve its sugar structure.
7421 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7422 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7423 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7424
7425 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7426 } else {
7427 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7428 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7429 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7430 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7431 FPT->isVariadic(),
7432 /*quals*/ 0,
7433 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7434 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7435 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7436 FPT->exception_begin(),
7437 Ext);
7438 }
7439
7440 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7441 } else {
7442 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7443 false, false, 0, 0,
7444 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7445 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007446
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007447 // FIXME: Check that return/parameter types are complete/non-abstract
John McCall8e346702010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007448 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7449 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007450 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007451
Chris Lattner45542ea2009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007452 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCallaab3e412010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007453 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007454 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007455
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007456 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007457
7458 bool Good = true;
7459 // Check goto/label use.
7460 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7461 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7462 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7463
7464 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7465 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007466 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0) {
7467 if (!L->isUsed())
7468 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::warn_unused_label) << L->getName();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007469 continue;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis72664df2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007470 }
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007471
7472 // Emit error.
7473 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7474 Good = false;
7475 }
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007476 if (!Good) {
7477 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stump314825b2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007478 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007479 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007480
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007481 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7482 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7483
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007484 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenek0b405322010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007485 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7486 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCall1d570a72010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007487 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenek918fe842010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007488
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007489 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9a28e842010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007490 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroffc540d662008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007491}
7492
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007493ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallba7bf592010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007494 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007495 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007496 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7497 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007498 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007499}
7500
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007501ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb268a282010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007502 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007503 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007504 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007505
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007506 // Get the va_list type
7507 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007508 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
7509 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
7510 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
7511 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007512 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007513 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
7514 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
7515 } else {
7516 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
7517 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007518 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007519 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedmane2cad652009-05-16 12:46:54 +00007520 return ExprError();
7521 }
Eli Friedman121ba0c2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007522
Douglas Gregorad3150c2009-05-19 23:10:31 +00007523 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
7524 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007525 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
7526 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner56382aa2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007527 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner3f5cd772009-04-05 00:59:53 +00007528 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007529
Eli Friedmanba961a92009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007530 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007531 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007532
Abramo Bagnara27db2392010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007533 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7534 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7e13ab82007-10-15 20:28:48 +00007535}
7536
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007537ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007538 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
7539 // pointers on the target.
7540 QualType Ty;
7541 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
7542 Ty = Context.IntTy;
7543 else
7544 Ty = Context.LongTy;
7545
Sebastian Redl6d4256c2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007546 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor3be4b122008-11-29 04:51:27 +00007547}
7548
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007549static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007550 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007551 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
7552 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007553
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007554 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7555 if (!PT)
7556 return;
7557
7558 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
7559 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
7560 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
7561 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
7562 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
7563 return;
7564 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007565
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007566 // Strip off any parens and casts.
7567 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
7568 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
7569 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007570
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007571 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007572}
7573
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007574bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
7575 SourceLocation Loc,
7576 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007577 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
7578 bool *Complained) {
7579 if (Complained)
7580 *Complained = false;
7581
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007582 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
7583 bool isInvalid = false;
7584 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007585 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007586
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007587 switch (ConvTy) {
7588 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
7589 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007590 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007591 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
7592 break;
Chris Lattner940cfeb2008-01-04 18:22:42 +00007593 case IntToPointer:
7594 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
7595 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007596 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007597 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007598 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
7599 break;
Eli Friedman80160bd2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00007600 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
7601 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
7602 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007603 case FunctionVoidPointer:
7604 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
7605 break;
7606 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregoraa1e21d2008-09-12 00:47:35 +00007607 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
7608 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
7609 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
7610 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
7611 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
7612 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
7613 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
7614 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
7615 // C++ semantics.
7616 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
7617 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
7618 return false;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007619 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
7620 break;
Alexis Hunt6f3de502009-11-08 07:46:34 +00007621 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanianb98dade2009-11-09 22:16:37 +00007622 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahaniand7aa9d82009-11-07 20:20:40 +00007623 break;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007624 case IntToBlockPointer:
7625 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
7626 break;
7627 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stumpd79b5a82009-04-21 22:51:42 +00007628 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff081c7422008-09-04 15:10:53 +00007629 break;
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007630 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007631 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff8afa9892008-10-14 22:18:38 +00007632 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
7633 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
7634 break;
Anders Carlssondb5a9b62009-01-30 23:17:46 +00007635 case IncompatibleVectors:
7636 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
7637 break;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007638 case Incompatible:
7639 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
7640 isInvalid = true;
7641 break;
7642 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007643
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007644 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
7645 switch (Action) {
7646 case AA_Assigning:
7647 case AA_Initializing:
7648 // The destination type comes first.
7649 FirstType = DstType;
7650 SecondType = SrcType;
7651 break;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007652
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007653 case AA_Returning:
7654 case AA_Passing:
7655 case AA_Converting:
7656 case AA_Sending:
7657 case AA_Casting:
7658 // The source type comes first.
7659 FirstType = SrcType;
7660 SecondType = DstType;
7661 break;
7662 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007663
Douglas Gregorc68e1402010-04-09 00:35:39 +00007664 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonace5d072009-11-10 04:46:30 +00007665 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregor4f4946a2010-04-22 00:20:18 +00007666 if (Complained)
7667 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner9bad62c2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00007668 return isInvalid;
7669}
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007670
Chris Lattnerc71d08b2009-04-25 21:59:05 +00007671bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007672 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
7673 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
7674 if (Result)
7675 *Result = ICEResult;
7676 return false;
7677 }
7678
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007679 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
7680
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007681 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007682 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
7683 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
7684
7685 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
7686 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
7687 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
7688 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
7689 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
7690 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
7691 }
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007692
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007693 return true;
7694 }
7695
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007696 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
7697 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007698
Eli Friedmanbb967cc2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00007699 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
7700 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
7701 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stump4e1f26a2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007702
Anders Carlssone54e8a12008-11-30 19:50:32 +00007703 if (Result)
7704 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
7705 return false;
7706}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007707
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007708void
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007709Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007710 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
7711 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007712}
7713
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007714void
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007715Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
7716 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
7717 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
7718 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007719
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007720 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
7721 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
7722 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
7723 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
7724 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007725 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregorfab31f42009-12-12 07:57:52 +00007726 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
7727 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
7728 I != IEnd; ++I)
7729 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
7730 }
7731
7732 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
7733 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
7734 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
7735 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
7736 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
7737 I != IEnd; ++I)
7738 Diag(I->first, I->second);
7739 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007740 }
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007741
7742 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
7743 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
7744 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
7745 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007746 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007747 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
7748 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
7749 ExprTemporaries.end());
7750
7751 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
7752 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007753}
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007754
7755/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
7756///
7757/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
7758/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
7759/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
7760/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
7761///
7762/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
7763///
7764/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
7765void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
7766 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007767
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007768 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007769 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007770
Douglas Gregor3beaf9b2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00007771 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
7772 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
7773 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
7774 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007775 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007776 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007777 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007778 return;
7779 }
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007780
Douglas Gregorfd27fed2010-04-07 20:29:57 +00007781 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
7782 return;
Alexis Huntc46382e2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00007783
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007784 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
7785 // an instantiation.
7786 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
7787 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007788
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007789 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007790 case Unevaluated:
7791 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
7792 return;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007793
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007794 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
7795 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
7796 // "used"; handle this below.
7797 break;
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007798
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007799 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
7800 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
7801 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
7802 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregorff790f12009-11-26 00:44:06 +00007803 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007804 return;
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007805
7806 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
7807 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
7808 // containing expression is used.
7809 return;
Douglas Gregor0b6a6242009-06-22 20:57:11 +00007810 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007811
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007812 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanian3a363432009-06-22 17:30:33 +00007813 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007814 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian18eb69a2009-06-22 20:37:23 +00007815 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruthc9262402010-08-23 07:55:51 +00007816 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
7817 return;
7818 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
7819 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007820 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor507eb872009-12-22 00:34:07 +00007821 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007822 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian477d2422009-06-22 23:34:40 +00007823 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
7824 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007825
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007826 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007827 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007828 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian24a175b2009-06-26 23:49:16 +00007829 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007830 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
7831 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007832 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
7833 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
7834 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorebada0772010-06-17 23:14:26 +00007835 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregora57478e2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00007836 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor88d292c2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00007837 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
7838 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian41f79272009-06-25 21:45:19 +00007839 }
Fariborz Jahanian49796cc72009-06-24 22:09:44 +00007840 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007841 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor4adbc6d2009-06-26 00:10:03 +00007842 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor69f6a362010-05-17 17:34:56 +00007843 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007844 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
7845 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
7846 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
7847 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7848 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007849 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007850 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007851 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007852 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007853 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
7854 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
7855 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007856 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregorafca3b42009-10-27 20:53:28 +00007857 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007858 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
7859 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007860
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007861 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
7862 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
7863 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
7864 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
7865 Loc));
7866 else
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007867 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor7f792cf2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00007868 }
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007869 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
7870 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
7871 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greif34ecff22010-08-28 01:58:12 +00007872 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greifb6aba3e2010-08-28 00:16:06 +00007873 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
7874 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007875
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007876 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidisdfffabd2010-08-25 10:34:54 +00007877
7878 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
7879 if (CurContext != Function)
7880 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007881
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007882 return;
Douglas Gregor77b50e12009-06-22 23:06:13 +00007883 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007884
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007885 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007886 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007887 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007888 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
7889 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
7890 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
7891 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
7892 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
7893 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth54080172010-08-25 08:44:16 +00007894 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregor06db9f52009-10-12 20:18:28 +00007895 }
7896 }
Mike Stump11289f42009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007897
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007898 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007899
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007900 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregora6ef8f02009-07-24 20:34:43 +00007901 return;
Sam Weinigbae69142009-09-11 03:29:30 +00007902 }
Douglas Gregorc9c02ed2009-06-19 23:52:42 +00007903}
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00007904
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007905namespace {
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007906 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007907 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007908 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007909 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
7910 Sema &S;
7911 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007912
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007913 public:
7914 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007915
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007916 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007917
7918 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
7919 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007920 };
7921}
7922
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007923bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
7924 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007925 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
7926 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
7927 }
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007928
7929 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007930}
7931
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007932bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007933 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
7934 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
7935 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007936 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.getFlatArgumentList(),
7937 Args.flat_size());
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007938 }
7939
Chandler Carruthc65667c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00007940 return true;
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007941}
7942
7943void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
7944 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthaf80f662010-06-09 08:17:30 +00007945 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregor5597ab42010-05-07 23:12:07 +00007946}
7947
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007948namespace {
7949 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
7950 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
7951 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
7952 Sema &S;
7953
7954 public:
7955 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
7956
7957 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
7958
7959 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
7960 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
7961 }
7962
7963 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
7964 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007965 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007966 }
7967
7968 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
7969 if (E->getConstructor())
7970 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
7971 if (E->getOperatorNew())
7972 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
7973 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
7974 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007975 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007976 }
7977
7978 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
7979 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
7980 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor6ed2fee2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00007981 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
7982 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
7983 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
7984 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
7985 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
7986 }
7987
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007988 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007989 }
7990
7991 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
7992 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor32b3de52010-09-11 23:32:50 +00007993 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00007994 }
7995
7996 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
7997 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
7998 }
7999 };
8000}
8001
8002/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
8003/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8004void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
8005 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
8006}
8007
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008008/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
8009/// of the program being compiled.
8010///
8011/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008012/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008013/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
8014/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
8015/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
8016/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008017/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008018/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008019///
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008020/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
8021/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
8022/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
8023/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008024bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008025 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
8026 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
8027 case Unevaluated:
8028 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
8029 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008030
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008031 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregor8a01b2a2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008032 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008033 Diag(Loc, PD);
8034 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008035
Douglas Gregorda8cdbc2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008036 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
8037 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
8038 break;
8039 }
8040
8041 return false;
8042}
8043
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008044bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
8045 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
8046 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
8047 return false;
8048
8049 PartialDiagnostic Note =
8050 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
8051 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
8052 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008053
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008054 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008055 FD ?
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008056 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
8057 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008058 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson7f84ed92009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008059 << CE->getSourceRange(),
8060 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
8061 return true;
8062
8063 return false;
8064}
8065
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008066// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
8067// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
8068void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
8069 SourceLocation Loc;
8070
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008071 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
8072
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008073 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
8074 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCalle3027922010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008075 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008076 return;
8077
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008078 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
8079 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
8080 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
8081 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
8082
John McCallb0e419e2009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008083 // self = [<foo> init...]
8084 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
8085 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
8086 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8087
8088 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
8089 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
8090 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
8091 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8092 }
John McCall0506e4a2009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008093
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008094 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8095 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
8096 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
8097 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
8098 return;
8099
8100 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8101 } else {
8102 // Not an assignment.
8103 return;
8104 }
8105
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008106 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCalle724ae92009-10-12 22:25:59 +00008107 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnamba2c6522010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008108
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008109 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregorfa1e36d2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00008110 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregora771f462010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008111 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor2bf2d3d2010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008112 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
8113 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
8114 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008115}
8116
8117bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8118 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
8119
8120 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Douglas Gregorb92a1562010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008121 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCalld5707ab2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008122
8123 QualType T = E->getType();
8124
8125 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
8126 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
8127 return true;
8128 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
8129 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
8130 << T << E->getSourceRange();
8131 return true;
8132 }
8133 }
8134
8135 return false;
8136}
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008137
John McCalldadc5752010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008138ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
8139 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregor12cc7ee2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00008140 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008141 return ExprError();
8142
Douglas Gregorb412e172010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008143 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008144 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregore60e41a2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008145
8146 return Owned(Sub);
8147}
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008148
8149/// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
8150/// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
8151ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8152 const BuiltinType *BT = E->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8153 if (!BT || !BT->isPlaceholderType()) return Owned(E);
8154
8155 // If this is overload, check for a single overload.
8156 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
8157 if (FunctionDecl *Specialization
8158 = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(E)) {
8159 // The access doesn't really matter in this case.
8160 DeclAccessPair Found = DeclAccessPair::make(Specialization,
8161 Specialization->getAccess());
8162 E = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, Found, Specialization);
8163 if (!E) return ExprError();
8164 return Owned(E);
8165 }
8166
John McCall36226622010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008167 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ovl_unresolvable) << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall36e7fe32010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008168 return ExprError();
8169 }
8170
8171 // Otherwise it's a use of undeduced auto.
8172 assert(BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::UndeducedAuto);
8173
8174 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens());
8175 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
8176 << DRE->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
8177 return ExprError();
8178}